blob: 949a38398aa651d9a3e02fdbfb45b552c48f722d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200459 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200460 - noepoll
461 - nokqueue
462 - nopoll
463 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200468 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100469 - tune.maxaccept
470 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200471 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200472 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100473 - tune.rcvbuf.client
474 - tune.rcvbuf.server
475 - tune.sndbuf.client
476 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100477
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478 * Debugging
479 - debug
480 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481
482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004833.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484------------------------------------
485
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200486ca-base <dir>
487 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200488 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
489 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200490
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200491chroot <jail dir>
492 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
493 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
494 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
495 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
496 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
497 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200499crt-base <dir>
500 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
501 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
502 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
503
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504daemon
505 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
506 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
507 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
508
509gid <number>
510 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
511 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
512 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
513 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100514
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200515group <group name>
516 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
517 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100518
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200519log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200520 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
521 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100522 configured with "log global".
523
524 <address> can be one of:
525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100526 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100527 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
528 port).
529
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100530 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
531 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
532 port).
533
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100534 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
535 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
536 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
537 writeable).
538
539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540
541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
544
545 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200546 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
547 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
548 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
549 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
550 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
551 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200553 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200554
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100555log-send-hostname [<string>]
556 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
557 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
558 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
559 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
560 the logs.
561
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000562log-tag <string>
563 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
564 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
565 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
566 running on the same host.
567
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200568nbproc <number>
569 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
570 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
571 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
572 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
573 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
574
575pidfile <pidfile>
576 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
577 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
578 starting the process. See also "daemon".
579
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200580stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
581 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
582 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
583 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
584 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
585 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
586 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
587 the number of processes used.
588
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200589stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
590 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
591 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
592 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
593 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200594
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200595 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
596 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
597 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
600 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
601 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100602 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603
604stats maxconn <connections>
605 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
606 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608uid <number>
609 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
610 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
611 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
612 one. See also "gid" and "user".
613
614ulimit-n <number>
615 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
616 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
617 option.
618
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100619unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
620 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
621
622 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
623 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
624 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
625 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
626 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
627 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
628 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
629 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
630 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
631 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633user <user name>
634 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
635 See also "uid" and "group".
636
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200637node <name>
638 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
639
640 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
641 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
642 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
643 traffic.
644
645description <text>
646 Add a text that describes the instance.
647
648 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
649 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
650 "<" and ">" characters.
651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006533.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200654-----------------------
655
656maxconn <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
658 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
659 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
660 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
661
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200662maxconnrate <number>
663 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
664 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
665 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
666 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
667 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
668 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
669 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
670 fairness.
671
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100672maxpipes <number>
673 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
674 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
675 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
676 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
677 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
678 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
679
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200680maxsslconn <number>
681 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
682 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
683 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
684 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
685 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
686 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
687 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689noepoll
690 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
691 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
692 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
693
694nokqueue
695 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
696 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
697 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
698
699nopoll
700 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
701 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100702 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
704 "nokqueue".
705
706nosepoll
707 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
708 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
709 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
710
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100711nosplice
712 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
713 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
714 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100715 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100716 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
717 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
718 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
719 "option splice-response".
720
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200721spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
722 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
723 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
724 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
725 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
726 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
727
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200728tune.bufsize <number>
729 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
730 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
731 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
732 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
733 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
734 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
735 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
736 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400737 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
738 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
739 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200740
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200741tune.chksize <number>
742 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
743 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
744 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
745 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
746 checks whenever possible.
747
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200748tune.http.maxhdr <number>
749 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
750 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
751 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
752 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
753 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
754 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
755 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
756 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
757 limit too high.
758
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100759tune.maxaccept <number>
760 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
761 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
762 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100763 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100764 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
765 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100766 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100767 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
768
769tune.maxpollevents <number>
770 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
771 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
772 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
773 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
774 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
775
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200776tune.maxrewrite <number>
777 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
778 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
779 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
780 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
781 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
782 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
783 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
784 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
785 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
786 bufsize.
787
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200788tune.pipesize <number>
789 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
790 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
791 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
792 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
793 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
794 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
795
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100796tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
797tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
798 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
799 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
800 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
801 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
802 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
803 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
804 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
805
806tune.sndbuf.client <number>
807tune.sndbuf.server <number>
808 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
809 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
810 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
811 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
812 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
813 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
814 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
815 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
816 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
817 notifying haproxy again.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008203.3. Debugging
821--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822
823debug
824 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
825 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
826 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
827 system startup.
828
829quiet
830 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
831 line argument "-q".
832
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008343.4. Userlists
835--------------
836It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
837http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
838it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
839
840userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100841 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100842 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
843
844group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100845 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
847 proceeded by "users" keyword.
848
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100849user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
850 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100851 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
852 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100853 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
854 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100855 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
856 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
857
858
859 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100860 userlist L1
861 group G1 users tiger,scott
862 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100863
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100864 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
865 user scott insecure-password elgato
866 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100868 userlist L2
869 group G1
870 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100872 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
873 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
874 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100875
876 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200877
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200878
8793.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200880----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200881It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
882haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
883pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
884identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
885or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
886Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
887known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
888the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
889process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
890during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
891tables.
892
893peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400894 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200895 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
896
897peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
898 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
899 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
900 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
901 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
902 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
903 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
904
905 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
906 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
907
908 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
909 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
910 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
911 across all peers.
912
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200913 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200914 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100915 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
916 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
917 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200918
919 backend mybackend
920 mode tcp
921 balance roundrobin
922 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
923 stick on src
924
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100925 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
926 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200927
928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200930----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200932Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
933 - defaults <name>
934 - frontend <name>
935 - backend <name>
936 - listen <name>
937
938A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
939its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
940section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100941section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200942
943A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
944connections.
945
946A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
947to forward incoming connections.
948
949A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
950parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
953'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
954case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
955
956Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
957logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
958proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
959However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
960name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
961
962Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
963and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100964bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
966modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
967arbitrary criteria.
968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009704.1. Proxy keywords matrix
971--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200973The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
974limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
975they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
976limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100977marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200978option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200979and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
980with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
981specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100982
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100984 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
985------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
986acl - X X X
987appsession - - X X
988backlog X X X -
989balance X - X X
990bind - X X -
991bind-process X X X X
992block - X X X
993capture cookie - X X -
994capture request header - X X -
995capture response header - X X -
996clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +0200997compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100998contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
999cookie X - X X
1000default-server X - X X
1001default_backend X X X -
1002description - X X X
1003disabled X X X X
1004dispatch - - X X
1005enabled X X X X
1006errorfile X X X X
1007errorloc X X X X
1008errorloc302 X X X X
1009-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1010errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001011force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001012fullconn X - X X
1013grace X X X X
1014hash-type X - X X
1015http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001016http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001017http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001018http-request - X X X
1019id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001020ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001021log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022maxconn X X X -
1023mode X X X X
1024monitor fail - X X -
1025monitor-net X X X -
1026monitor-uri X X X -
1027option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1028option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1029option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1030option allbackups (*) X - X X
1031option checkcache (*) X - X X
1032option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1033option contstats (*) X X X -
1034option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1035option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1036option forceclose (*) X X X X
1037-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1038option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001039option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001040option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1042option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1043option httpchk X - X X
1044option httpclose (*) X X X X
1045option httplog X X X X
1046option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001047option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001048option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001049option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1050option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1051option logasap (*) X X X -
1052option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001053option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001054option nolinger (*) X X X X
1055option originalto X X X X
1056option persist (*) X - X X
1057option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001058option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001059option smtpchk X - X X
1060option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1061option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1062option splice-request (*) X X X X
1063option splice-response (*) X X X X
1064option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1065option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1066-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1067option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1068option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1069option tcpka X X X X
1070option tcplog X X X X
1071option transparent (*) X - X X
1072persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1073rate-limit sessions X X X -
1074redirect - X X X
1075redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1076redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1077reqadd - X X X
1078reqallow - X X X
1079reqdel - X X X
1080reqdeny - X X X
1081reqiallow - X X X
1082reqidel - X X X
1083reqideny - X X X
1084reqipass - X X X
1085reqirep - X X X
1086reqisetbe - X X X
1087reqitarpit - X X X
1088reqpass - X X X
1089reqrep - X X X
1090-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1091reqsetbe - X X X
1092reqtarpit - X X X
1093retries X - X X
1094rspadd - X X X
1095rspdel - X X X
1096rspdeny - X X X
1097rspidel - X X X
1098rspideny - X X X
1099rspirep - X X X
1100rsprep - X X X
1101server - - X X
1102source X - X X
1103srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001104stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001105stats auth X - X X
1106stats enable X - X X
1107stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001108stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109stats realm X - X X
1110stats refresh X - X X
1111stats scope X - X X
1112stats show-desc X - X X
1113stats show-legends X - X X
1114stats show-node X - X X
1115stats uri X - X X
1116-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1117stick match - - X X
1118stick on - - X X
1119stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001120stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001122tcp-request connection - X X -
1123tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001124tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001125tcp-response content - - X X
1126tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001127timeout check X - X X
1128timeout client X X X -
1129timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1130timeout connect X - X X
1131timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1132timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1133timeout http-request X X X X
1134timeout queue X - X X
1135timeout server X - X X
1136timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1137timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001138timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001140unique-id-format X X X -
1141unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001142use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001143use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001144------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1145 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011484.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1149---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150
1151This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1152
1153
1154acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1155 Declare or complete an access list.
1156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1157 no | yes | yes | yes
1158 Example:
1159 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1160 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1161 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001163 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001164
1165
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001166appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1167 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001168 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1170 no | no | yes | yes
1171 Arguments :
1172 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1173 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1174
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001175 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001176 checked in each cookie value.
1177
1178 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1179 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1180 milliseconds.
1181
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001182 request-learn
1183 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1184 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1185 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1186 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1187 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1188 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1189
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001190 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1191 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1192 data following this prefix.
1193
1194 Example :
1195 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1196
1197 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1198 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1199
1200 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1201 2 modes are currently supported :
1202 - path-parameters :
1203 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1204 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1205 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1206 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1207 - query-string :
1208 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1209 query string.
1210
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001211 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1212 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1213 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1214 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001215 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1216 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1217 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001218 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1219 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1220
1221 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1222
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001223 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1224 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1225 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001227 Example :
1228 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1229
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001230 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1231 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232
1233
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001234backlog <conns>
1235 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1237 yes | yes | yes | no
1238 Arguments :
1239 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1240 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001241 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001242
1243 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1244 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1245 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1246 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1247 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1248 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1249 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1250 backlog parameter.
1251
1252 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1253 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1254 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1255
1256 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1257
1258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001259balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001260balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1263 yes | no | yes | yes
1264 Arguments :
1265 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1266 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1267 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1268 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1269
1270 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1271 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1272 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1273 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001274 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1275 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1276 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1277 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1278 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1279 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1280 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1281 it, so that you don't worry.
1282
1283 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1284 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1285 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1286 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1287 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1288 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1289 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1290 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001292 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1293 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1294 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1295 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1296 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1297 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1298 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1299 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1300
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001301 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1302 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1303 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1304 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001305 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001306 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1307 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1308 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1309 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1310 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001311 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1312 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1313 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1314 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1315 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1316 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001318 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1319 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1320 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1321 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1322 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1323 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1324 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1325 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001326 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001327 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001328 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1329 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1330 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001331
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001332 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1333 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1334 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1335 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1336 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1337 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1338 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1339 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1340 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1341 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1342 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1343 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001344
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001345 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001346 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1347 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1348 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1349 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1350 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1351 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1352 URIs start with a leading "/".
1353
1354 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1355 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1356 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1357 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001359 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001360 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1361
1362 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001363 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1364 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1365 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1366 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1367 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1368 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1369 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1370 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1371 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1372 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1373 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1374 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1375 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1376 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1377 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1378 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1379 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1380 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1381 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001382
1383 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1384 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1385 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1386 server will receive the request.
1387
1388 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1389 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1390 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1391 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1392 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001393 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1394 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1395 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001396
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001397 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1398 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1399 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1400 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1401 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001403 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001404 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1405 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1406 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1407
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001408 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1409 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1410 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1411
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001412 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001413 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001414 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1415 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1416 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1417 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1418 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1419 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001420 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001421 used instead.
1422
1423 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1424 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1425 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1426 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1427
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001428 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1429 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1430 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001432 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001434 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001435 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1436 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001437
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001438 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001440
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001441 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1442 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1443 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001444
1445 Examples :
1446 balance roundrobin
1447 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001448 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001449 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1450 balance hdr(host)
1451 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001452
1453 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1454 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001456 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001457 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1458 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1459 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1460 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1461
1462 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1463 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1464 defaults to 16 kB.
1465
1466 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1467 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1468
1469 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1470 Round Robin.
1471
1472 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1473 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1474 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1475 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1476
1477 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1478
1479 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001480 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001481 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1482 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1483 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001485 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1486 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1490bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | yes | yes | no
1494 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001495 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1496 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1497 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1498 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001499 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001500
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001501 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1502 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001503 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1504 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1505 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001506 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1507 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1508 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1509 the range.
1510
1511 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1512 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1513 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1514 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1515 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1516 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1517 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001518 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001519 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001520
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001521 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1522 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1523 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1524 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1525 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1526 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1527 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1528 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1529
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001530 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1531 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1532 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1533 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1536 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1537 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1538 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1539 in a frontend.
1540
1541 Example :
1542 listen http_proxy
1543 bind :80,:443
1544 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001545 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001546
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001547 listen http_https_proxy
1548 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001549 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001550
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001551 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001552 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001553
1554
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001555bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1556 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1558 yes | yes | yes | yes
1559 Arguments :
1560 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1561 may be used to override a default value.
1562
1563 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1564 option may be combined with other numbers.
1565
1566 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1567 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1568 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1569 missing from all processes.
1570
1571 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1572 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1573 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1574 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1575
1576 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1577 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1578 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1579 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1580 and 'even' instances.
1581
1582 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1583 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1584 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1585 32.
1586
1587 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1588 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1589
1590 Example :
1591 listen app_ip1
1592 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001593 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001594
1595 listen app_ip2
1596 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001597 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001598
1599 listen management
1600 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001601 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001602
1603 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1604
1605
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606block { if | unless } <condition>
1607 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1609 no | yes | yes | yes
1610
1611 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1612 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001613 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001614 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1616 "block" statements per instance.
1617
1618 Example:
1619 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1620 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1621 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1622 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001624 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625
1626
1627capture cookie <name> len <length>
1628 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1630 no | yes | yes | no
1631 Arguments :
1632 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1633 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1634 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1635 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1636 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1637
1638 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1639 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1640 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1641 right if it exceeds <length>.
1642
1643 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1644 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1645 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1646 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1647
1648 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1649 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1650 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1651
1652 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1653 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1654 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1655 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001656 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001657 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1658
1659 Example:
1660 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1661
1662 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001663 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001664
1665
1666capture request header <name> len <length>
1667 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1669 no | yes | yes | no
1670 Arguments :
1671 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001672 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001673 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1674 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1675 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1676
1677 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1678 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1679 it exceeds <length>.
1680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001681 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1683 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001684 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1685 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1686 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1687 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001688 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001689 environments to find where the request came from.
1690
1691 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1692 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1693 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1694 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
1696 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1697 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1698 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1699 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1700
1701 Example:
1702 capture request header Host len 15
1703 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1704 capture request header Referrer len 15
1705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001706 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001707 about logging.
1708
1709
1710capture response header <name> len <length>
1711 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1713 no | yes | yes | no
1714 Arguments :
1715 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001716 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1718 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1719 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1720
1721 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1722 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1723 it exceeds <length>.
1724
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001725 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1727 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1728 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001729 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1730 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1731 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1732 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
1734 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1735 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1736 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1737 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1738
1739 Example:
1740 capture response header Content-length len 9
1741 capture response header Location len 15
1742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001743 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744 about logging.
1745
1746
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001747clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1750 yes | yes | yes | no
1751 Arguments :
1752 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1753 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1754 as explained at the top of this document.
1755
1756 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1757 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1758 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1759 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1760 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1761 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1762 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1763 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001764 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001765 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1766 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1767
1768 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1769 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1770 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1771 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1772 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1773 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1774
1775 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1776 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1777
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001778 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1779 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001780
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001781compression algo [ gzip ] ...
1782compression type ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001783compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001784 Enable HTTP compression.
1785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1786 yes | yes | yes | yes
1787 Arguments :
1788 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1789 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001790 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1791
1792 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1793 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1794 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1795 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1796 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1797 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1798 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1799 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1800 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001801
1802 Examples :
1803 compression algo gzip
1804 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001806contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1809 yes | no | yes | yes
1810 Arguments :
1811 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1813 as explained at the top of this document.
1814
1815 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001816 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001817 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1819 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1820 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1821 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1822
1823 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1824 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1825 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1826 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1827 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1828 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1829
1830 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1831 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1832 instead.
1833
1834 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1835 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1836
1837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001838cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001839 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1840 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001841 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1843 yes | no | yes | yes
1844 Arguments :
1845 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1846 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1847 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1848 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1849 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1850 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1851 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1852 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1853 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1854
1855 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1856 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1857 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1858 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1859 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1860 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1861 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1862 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1863 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1864 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1865 "insert" and "prefix".
1866
1867 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001868 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001869
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001870 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001871 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1872 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1873 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1874 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1875 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1876 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1877 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1878 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1879 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1880 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001881
1882 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1883 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1884 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1885 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1886 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1887 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1888 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1889 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1890 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1891 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001892 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1893 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1894 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001896 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1897 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1898 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001899 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1900 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1901 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1902 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001903 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1904 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1905 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1908 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1909 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1910 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1911 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1912 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1913 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1914 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1915 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1916
1917 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1918 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1919 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1920 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1921 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1922 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1923 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1924 persistence cookie in the cache.
1925 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1926
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001927 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1928 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1929 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1930 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1931 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1932 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1933 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1934 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1935 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1936 they logout.
1937
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001938 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1939 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1940 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1941 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1942
1943 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1944 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1945 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1946 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
1947 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
1948 this attribute.
1949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001950 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001951 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001952 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1953 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1954 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1955 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1956 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1957 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001958
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001959 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1960 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1961 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1962 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1963 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1964 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1965 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1966 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1967 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1968 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1969 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1970 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1971 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1972 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1973 the site.
1974
1975 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1976 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1977 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1978 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1979 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1980 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1981 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1982 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1983 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1984 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1985 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1986 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1987 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1988 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1989 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1990 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1993 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1994 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1995 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001997 Examples :
1998 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1999 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2000 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002001 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002003 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002004 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002007default-server [param*]
2008 Change default options for a server in a backend
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 yes | no | yes | yes
2011 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002012 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2013 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2014 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2015 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002016
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002017 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002018 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2019
2020 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023default_backend <backend>
2024 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2026 yes | yes | yes | no
2027 Arguments :
2028 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2029
2030 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2031 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2032 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2033 will catch all undetermined requests.
2034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 Example :
2036
2037 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2038 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2039 default_backend dynamic
2040
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002041 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002043
2044disabled
2045 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2047 yes | yes | yes | yes
2048 Arguments : none
2049
2050 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2051 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2052 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2053 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2054 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2055 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2056 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2057
2058 See also : "enabled"
2059
2060
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002061dispatch <address>:<port>
2062 Set a default server address
2063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2064 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002065 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002066
2067 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2068 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2069 during start-up.
2070
2071 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2072 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2073 possible with normal servers.
2074
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002075 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002076 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2077 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2078 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2079 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2080
2081 See also : "server"
2082
2083
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084enabled
2085 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2087 yes | yes | yes | yes
2088 Arguments : none
2089
2090 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2091 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2092
2093 See also : "disabled"
2094
2095
2096errorfile <code> <file>
2097 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2099 yes | yes | yes | yes
2100 Arguments :
2101 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002102 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103
2104 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002105 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002107 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2108 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002109
2110 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2111 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2112 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2113
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002114 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2117 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2118 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2119 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2120
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002121 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2122 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2123 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2124 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2125 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2126 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2129 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2130 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002131 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002132 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2133
2134 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2135
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002136 Example :
2137 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2138 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2139 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2140
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002141
2142errorloc <code> <url>
2143errorloc302 <code> <url>
2144 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2146 yes | yes | yes | yes
2147 Arguments :
2148 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002149 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002150
2151 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2152 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2153 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2154 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2155 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2156
2157 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2158 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2159 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2160
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002161 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2162
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002163 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2164 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2165 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2166 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2167 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2168 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2169 request.
2170
2171 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2172
2173
2174errorloc303 <code> <url>
2175 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2177 yes | yes | yes | yes
2178 Arguments :
2179 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2180 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2181
2182 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2183 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2184 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2185 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2186 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2187
2188 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2189 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2190 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2191
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002192 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002194 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2195 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2196 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2197 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002198 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002199
2200 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2201
2202
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002203force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2204 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | yes
2207
2208 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2209 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2210 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2211 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2212 marked down for maintenance operations.
2213
2214 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2215 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2216 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2217 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2218 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2219 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2220 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2221 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2222 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2223
2224 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2225 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2226 is used.
2227
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002228 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002229 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002230
2231
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002232fullconn <conns>
2233 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2235 yes | no | yes | yes
2236 Arguments :
2237 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2238 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2239
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002240 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002241 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002242 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002243 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2244 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2245 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2246 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2247 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002249
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002250 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2251 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2252 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2253
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002254 Example :
2255 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2256 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2257 # connections.
2258 backend dynamic
2259 fullconn 10000
2260 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2261 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2262
2263 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2264
2265
2266grace <time>
2267 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002269 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002270 Arguments :
2271 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2272 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2273 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2274
2275 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2276 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002277 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002278 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2279
2280 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2281 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2282 simplify it.
2283
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002285hash-type <method>
2286 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | no | yes | yes
2289 Arguments :
2290 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2291 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2292 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2293 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2294 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2295 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2296 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2297 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2298 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2299
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002300 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2301 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2302 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2303 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2304 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2305 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2306 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2307 this value.
2308
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002309 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2310 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2311 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2312 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2313 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2314 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2315 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2316 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2317 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2318 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2319 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2320 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2321 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2322
2323 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2324
2325 See also : "balance", "server"
2326
2327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328http-check disable-on-404
2329 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002331 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 Arguments : none
2333
2334 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2335 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2336 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2337 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2338 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2339 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2340 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2341 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002342 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2343 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2344 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2345
2346 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2347
2348
2349http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002350 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002352 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002353 Arguments :
2354 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2355 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002356 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002357 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2358 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2359 details on the supported keywords.
2360
2361 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2362 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2363 with the usual backslash ('\').
2364
2365 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2366 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2367 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2368 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2369 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2370
2371 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002372 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002373 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2374 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2375 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2376
2377 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002378 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002379 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2380 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2381 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2382 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2383
2384 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002385 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002386 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2387 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2388 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2389 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2390 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2391 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2392 trace).
2393
2394 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002395 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002396 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2397 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2398 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2399 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2400 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2401 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2402
2403 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2404 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2405 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2406 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2407 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2408 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2409 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2410 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2411
2412 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2413 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2414
2415 Examples :
2416 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002417 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002418
2419 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002420 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002421
2422 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002423 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002424
2425 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002426 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002427
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002428 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002429
2430
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002431http-check send-state
2432 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 yes | no | yes | yes
2435 Arguments : none
2436
2437 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2438 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2439 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2440 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2441 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2442
2443 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2444 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2445 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2446 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2447 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2448 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2449 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2450 checked in multiple backends.
2451
2452 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2453 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2454
2455 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2456 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2457 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2458 one fails.
2459
2460 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2461 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2462 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2463
2464 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2465 server's queue.
2466
2467 Example of a header received by the application server :
2468 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2469 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2470
2471 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2472
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002473http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002474 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002475 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2476
2477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2478 no | yes | yes | yes
2479
2480 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2481 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2482 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002483 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2484 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002485 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2486
2487 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2488 instance.
2489
2490 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002491 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2492 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2493 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002494
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002495 http-request allow if nagios
2496 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2497 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2498 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002499
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002500 Example:
2501 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002502
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002503 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002504
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002505 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2506 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002507
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002508http-send-name-header [<header>]
2509 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2510
2511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | no | yes | yes
2513
2514 Arguments :
2515
2516 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2517
2518 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2519 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2520 is added with the header string proved.
2521
2522 See also : "server"
2523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002524id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002525 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 no | yes | yes | yes
2528 Arguments : none
2529
2530 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2531 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2532 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002533
2534
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002535ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2536 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2538 no | yes | yes | yes
2539
2540 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2541 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2542 and running).
2543
2544 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2545 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2546 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2547 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2548 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2549
2550 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2551 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2552
2553 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2554 "unless" condition is met.
2555
2556 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2557
2558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002559log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002560log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002561no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002562 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2564 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002565
2566 Prefix :
2567 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2568 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2569 prefix does not allow arguments.
2570
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571 Arguments :
2572 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2573 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2574 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2575 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2576 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2577 parameter.
2578
2579 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2580 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2581
2582 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2583 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2584 standard syslog port).
2585
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002586 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2587 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2588 standard syslog port).
2589
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002590 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2591 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2592 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2593 appropriately writeable).
2594
2595 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2596
2597 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2598 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2599 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2600
2601 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2602 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2603 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002604 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2605 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2606 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2607 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2608 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609
2610 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2611
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002612 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2613 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2614 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002615
2616 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2617 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2618 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2619 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2620
2621 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2622 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002623
2624 Example :
2625 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002626 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2627 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002628
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002629log-format <string>
2630 Allows you to custom a log line.
2631
2632 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2633
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002634
2635maxconn <conns>
2636 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 yes | yes | yes | no
2639 Arguments :
2640 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2641 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2642 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2643 closes.
2644
2645 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2646 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2647 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2648 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2649 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2650 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2651 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2652 properly tuned.
2653
2654 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2655 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2656 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2657
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002658 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2659
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002660 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2661
2662
2663mode { tcp|http|health }
2664 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2666 yes | yes | yes | yes
2667 Arguments :
2668 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2669 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2670 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2671 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2672
2673 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2674 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2675 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2676 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2677 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2678
2679 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002680 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2681 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2682 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2683 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2684 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2685 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2686 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002687
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002688 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2689 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2690 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002691
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002692 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 defaults http_instances
2694 mode http
2695
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002696 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002697
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002698
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002699monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002700 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2702 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 Arguments :
2704 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2705 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002706 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2708 backend and its backup.
2709
2710 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2711 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2712 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2713 servers in a list of backends.
2714
2715 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2716 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2717 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2718 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2719 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2720 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2721 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002722 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2723 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002724
2725 Example:
2726 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002727 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2729 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2730 monitor-uri /site_alive
2731 monitor fail if site_dead
2732
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002733 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002734
2735
2736monitor-net <source>
2737 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2739 yes | yes | yes | no
2740 Arguments :
2741 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2742 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2743 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2744 followed by a mask.
2745
2746 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2747 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002748 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002749 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2750
2751 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2752 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2753 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2754 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002755 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2756 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2757 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002758
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002759 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2760 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2761 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2762 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2763 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2764 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002765
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002766 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2767 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002768
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002769 Example :
2770 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2771 frontend www
2772 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2773
2774 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2775
2776
2777monitor-uri <uri>
2778 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2780 yes | yes | yes | no
2781 Arguments :
2782 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2783 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2784
2785 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2786 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2787 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2788 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2789 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2790 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2791 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2792 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2793
2794 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2795 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2796 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2797 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2798 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2799 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2800
2801 Example :
2802 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2803 frontend www
2804 mode http
2805 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2806
2807 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2808
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002810option abortonclose
2811no option abortonclose
2812 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2814 yes | no | yes | yes
2815 Arguments : none
2816
2817 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2818 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2819 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2820 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002821 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002822 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2823 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2824 encountered while delivering the response.
2825
2826 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2827 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2828 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2829 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2830 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2831 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002832 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002833 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002834 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002835 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2836 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2837 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2838
2839 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2840 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2841 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2842 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2843 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2844 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2845 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2846 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002847 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002848
2849 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2850 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2851
2852 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2853
2854
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002855option accept-invalid-http-request
2856no option accept-invalid-http-request
2857 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2859 yes | yes | yes | no
2860 Arguments : none
2861
2862 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2863 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2864 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2865 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2866 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2867 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2868 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2869 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002870 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2871 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2872 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2873 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2874 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2875 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002876
2877 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2878 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2879 been confirmed.
2880
2881 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2882 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002883 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2884 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002885 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2886
2887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2889
2890 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2891 stats socket.
2892
2893
2894option accept-invalid-http-response
2895no option accept-invalid-http-response
2896 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 yes | no | yes | yes
2899 Arguments : none
2900
2901 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2902 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2903 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2904 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2905 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2906 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2907 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2908 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2909 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2910
2911 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2912 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2913 been confirmed.
2914
2915 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2916 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2917 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2918 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2919
2920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2922
2923 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2924 stats socket.
2925
2926
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002927option allbackups
2928no option allbackups
2929 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2931 yes | no | yes | yes
2932 Arguments : none
2933
2934 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2935 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2936 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2937 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2938 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2939 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2940 order between the backup servers anymore.
2941
2942 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2943 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2944
2945 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2946 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2947
2948
2949option checkcache
2950no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002951 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2953 yes | no | yes | yes
2954 Arguments : none
2955
2956 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2957 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002958 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2960 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002961 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002962
2963 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002964 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002965 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002966 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2967 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002968 to the client are :
2969 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002970 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002971 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002972 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2973 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2974 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2975 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2976 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2977 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2978 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2979 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2980 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2981 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2982 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2983
2984 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002985 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002986 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002987 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002988 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2989
2990 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2991 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002992 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002993 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2994
2995 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2996 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2997
2998
2999option clitcpka
3000no option clitcpka
3001 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3003 yes | yes | yes | no
3004 Arguments : none
3005
3006 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3007 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3008 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3009 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3010
3011 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3012 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3013 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3014 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3015
3016 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3017 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3018 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3019 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3020 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3021
3022 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3023
3024 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3025 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3026 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3027
3028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3030
3031 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3032
3033
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003034option contstats
3035 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3037 yes | yes | yes | no
3038 Arguments : none
3039
3040 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3041 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3042 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3043 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3044 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3045 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3046 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3047
3048
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003049option dontlog-normal
3050no option dontlog-normal
3051 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3053 yes | yes | yes | no
3054 Arguments : none
3055
3056 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3057 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3058 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3059 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3060 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3061 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3062 logged.
3063
3064 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3065 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3066 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003068 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003069 logging.
3070
3071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003072option dontlognull
3073no option dontlognull
3074 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3076 yes | yes | yes | no
3077 Arguments : none
3078
3079 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3080 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3081 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3082 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3083 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3084 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3085 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3086
3087 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3088 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3089 would not be logged.
3090
3091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003094 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003095
3096
3097option forceclose
3098no option forceclose
3099 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003102 Arguments : none
3103
3104 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3105 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3106 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3107 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3108 global session times in the logs.
3109
3110 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003111 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003112 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3113 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3114 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3115 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003116
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003117 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3118 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3119 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3120
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003121 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3122 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3123
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003124 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003125
3126
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003127option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003128 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3130 yes | yes | yes | yes
3131 Arguments :
3132 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3133 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003134 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003135 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003136
3137 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3138 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3139 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3140 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3141 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3142 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3143 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003144 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3145 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3146 possible that the client has already brought one.
3147
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003148 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003149 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003150 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3151 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003152 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3153 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003154
3155 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3156 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3157 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3158 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3159 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3160 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3161 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3162
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003163 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3164 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3165 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3166 are under the control of the end-user.
3167
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003168 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003169 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3170 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003171 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3172 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3173 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003174
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003175 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3176 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3177 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3178 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3179 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003180
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003181 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003182 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3183 frontend www
3184 mode http
3185 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3186
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003187 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3188 backend www
3189 mode http
3190 option forwardfor header X-Client
3191
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003192 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3193 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003194
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003195
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003196option http-no-delay
3197no option http-no-delay
3198 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3200 yes | yes | yes | yes
3201 Arguments : none
3202
3203 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3204 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3205 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3206 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3207 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3208 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3209 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3210 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3211 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3212 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3213 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3214 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3215 affected.
3216
3217 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3218 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3219 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3220 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3221 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3222 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3223 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3224 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3225 latency environments.
3226
3227
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003228option http-pretend-keepalive
3229no option http-pretend-keepalive
3230 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3232 yes | yes | yes | yes
3233 Arguments : none
3234
3235 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3236 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3237 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3238 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3239 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3240 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3241 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3242 consider the response complete.
3243
3244 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3245 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3246 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3247 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3248 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3249 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3250
3251 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3252 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3253 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3254 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3255 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3256 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3257 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3258
3259 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3260 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003261 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003262 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3263 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003264
3265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3267
3268 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3269
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003270
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003271option http-server-close
3272no option http-server-close
3273 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3275 yes | yes | yes | yes
3276 Arguments : none
3277
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003278 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3279 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3280 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3281 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3282 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3283 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3284 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3285 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3286 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3287 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3288 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3289 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003290
3291 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3292 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3293 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3294 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003295 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3296 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003297
3298 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3299 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003300 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3301 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3302 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003303
3304 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3305 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3306
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003307 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3308 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003309
3310
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003311option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003312no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003313 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3315 yes | yes | yes | no
3316 Arguments : none
3317
3318 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3319 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3320 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3321 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3322 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3323 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3324 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3325
3326 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3327 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3328 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3329 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3330 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3331 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3332 request along its whole life.
3333
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003334 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3335 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3336 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3337 front of an existing proxy.
3338
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003339 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3340
3341 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3342 http-server-close".
3343
3344
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003345option httpchk
3346option httpchk <uri>
3347option httpchk <method> <uri>
3348option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3349 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | no | yes | yes
3352 Arguments :
3353 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3354 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3355 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3356 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3357 ones.
3358
3359 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3360 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3361 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3362
3363 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3364 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3365 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3366 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3367 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3368
3369 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3370 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3371 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3372 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3373 the lack of any response.
3374
3375 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3376
3377 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3378 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3379 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3380
3381 Examples :
3382 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3383 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3384 backend https_relay
3385 mode tcp
3386 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3387 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3388
3389 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003390 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3391 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003392
3393
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003394option httpclose
3395no option httpclose
3396 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3398 yes | yes | yes | yes
3399 Arguments : none
3400
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003401 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3402 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3403 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3404 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3405 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3406 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3407 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003408
3409 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003410 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003411 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3412 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3413 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3414 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3415 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003416
3417 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3418 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3419 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003420 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3421 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003422
3423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3425
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003426 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3427 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003428
3429
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003430option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003431 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3433 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003434 Arguments :
3435 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3436 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3437 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3438 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3439 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003440
3441 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3442 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3443 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3444 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3445 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3446 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3447 ports.
3448
3449 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3450
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003451 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3452 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3453 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3454 by default.
3455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003456 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003457
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003458
3459option http_proxy
3460no option http_proxy
3461 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | yes
3464 Arguments : none
3465
3466 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3467 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3468 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3469 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3470 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3471
3472 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3473 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3474 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3475 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003476 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003477 be analyzed.
3478
3479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3481
3482 Example :
3483 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3484 backend direct_forward
3485 option httpclose
3486 option http_proxy
3487
3488 See also : "option httpclose"
3489
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003490
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003491option independent-streams
3492no option independent-streams
3493 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | yes
3496 Arguments : none
3497
3498 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3499 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3500 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3501 receive data or not.
3502
3503 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3504 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3505 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3506 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3507 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3508 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3509 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3510 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3511 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3512 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3513 socket buffers.
3514
3515 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3516 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3517 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3518 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3519 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3520
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003521 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3522 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3523 deprecated.
3524
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003525 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003526
3527
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003528option ldap-check
3529 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 yes | no | yes | yes
3532 Arguments : none
3533
3534 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3535 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3536 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3537 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3538
3539 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3540 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3541
3542 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3543 configure it.
3544
3545 Example :
3546 option ldap-check
3547
3548 See also : "option httpchk"
3549
3550
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003551option log-health-checks
3552no option log-health-checks
3553 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 yes | no | yes | yes
3556 Arguments : none
3557
3558 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3559 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3560 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3561 of additional information is limited.
3562
3563 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3564 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3565
3566 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3567
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003568
3569option log-separate-errors
3570no option log-separate-errors
3571 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3573 yes | yes | yes | no
3574 Arguments : none
3575
3576 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3577 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3578 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3579 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3580 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3581 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3582 provides very important information.
3583
3584 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3585 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3586 error logs.
3587
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003588 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003589 logging.
3590
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003591
3592option logasap
3593no option logasap
3594 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3596 yes | yes | yes | no
3597 Arguments : none
3598
3599 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3600 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3601 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3602 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3603 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3604 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3605 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003606 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003607 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3608 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3609
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003610 Examples :
3611 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3612 mode http
3613 option httplog
3614 option logasap
3615 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3616
3617 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3618 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3619 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3620 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003622 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003623 logging.
3624
3625
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003626option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3627 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3629 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003630 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003631 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3632 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003633
3634 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3635 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3636 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3637 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3638 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3639 in the MySQL table, like this :
3640
3641 USE mysql;
3642 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3643 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3644
3645 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3646 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3647 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3648 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3649 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3650 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3651 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3652 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3653 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3654
3655 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3656 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003657
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003658 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003659
3660 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3661 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3662 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3663 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3664 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3665 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3666
3667 See also: "option httpchk"
3668
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003669option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3670 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3672 yes | no | yes | yes
3673 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003674 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3675 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003676
3677 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3678 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3679 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3680 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3681
3682 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003683
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003684option nolinger
3685no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003686 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3688 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003689 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003690
3691 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3692 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3693 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3694 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3695 connections.
3696
3697 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3698 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3699 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3700 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3701 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3702 this too.
3703
3704 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3705 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3706 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3707
3708 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3709 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3710 for servers.
3711
3712 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3713 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3714
3715
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003716option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3717 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 yes | yes | yes | yes
3720 Arguments :
3721 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3722 matching <network>
3723 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3724 header name.
3725
3726 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3727 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3728 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3729 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3730 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3731 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3732 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3733 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3734 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3735 possible that the client has already brought one.
3736
3737 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3738 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3739 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3740 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3741 header and requires different one.
3742
3743 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3744 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3745 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3746 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3747 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3748 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3749 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3750
3751 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3752 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3753 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3754 both are defined.
3755
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003756 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3757 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3758 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3759 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3760 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003761
3762 Examples :
3763 # Original Destination address
3764 frontend www
3765 mode http
3766 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3767
3768 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3769 backend www
3770 mode http
3771 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3772
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003773 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3774 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003775
3776
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003777option persist
3778no option persist
3779 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003782 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003783
3784 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3785 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3786 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3787 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3788 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3789 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3790 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3791 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3792 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3793 redirected to another valid server.
3794
3795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3797
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003798 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003799
3800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003801option redispatch
3802no option redispatch
3803 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3805 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003806 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003807
3808 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3809 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3810 be able to access the service anymore.
3811
3812 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3813 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3814
3815 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3816 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3817 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003818
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003819 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3820 "redisp" keywords.
3821
3822 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3823 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3824
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003825 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003826
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003827
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003828option redis-check
3829 Use redis health checks for server testing
3830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3831 yes | no | yes | yes
3832 Arguments : none
3833
3834 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3835 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3836 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3837 find the "+PONG" response message.
3838
3839 Example :
3840 option redis-check
3841
3842 See also : "option httpchk"
3843
3844
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003845option smtpchk
3846option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3847 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3849 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003850 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003851 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3852 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3853 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3854
3855 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3856 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3857 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3858
3859 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3860 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3861 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3862 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3863 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3864 dead server.
3865
3866 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3867 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3868 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3869 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3870
3871 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3872 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3873 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3874 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3875 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3876
3877 Example :
3878 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3879
3880 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003883option socket-stats
3884no option socket-stats
3885
3886 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3888 yes | yes | yes | no
3889
3890 Arguments : none
3891
3892
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003893option splice-auto
3894no option splice-auto
3895 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 yes | yes | yes | yes
3898 Arguments : none
3899
3900 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3901 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3902 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3903 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003904 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003905 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3906 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3907 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3908 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3909
3910 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3911 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3912 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3913 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3914 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3915 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3916 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3917 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3918 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3919 keyword.
3920
3921 Example :
3922 option splice-auto
3923
3924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3926
3927 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3928 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3929
3930
3931option splice-request
3932no option splice-request
3933 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3935 yes | yes | yes | yes
3936 Arguments : none
3937
3938 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003939 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003940 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3941 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3942 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3943 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3944
3945 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3946
3947 Example :
3948 option splice-request
3949
3950 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3951 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3952
3953 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3954 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3955
3956
3957option splice-response
3958no option splice-response
3959 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3961 yes | yes | yes | yes
3962 Arguments : none
3963
3964 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003965 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003966 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3967 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3968 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3969 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3970
3971 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3972
3973 Example :
3974 option splice-response
3975
3976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3978
3979 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3980 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3981
3982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003983option srvtcpka
3984no option srvtcpka
3985 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | yes | yes
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3991 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3992 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3993 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3994
3995 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3996 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3997 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3998 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3999
4000 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4001 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4002 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4003 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4004 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4005
4006 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4007
4008 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4009 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4010 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4011
4012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4014
4015 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4016
4017
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004018option ssl-hello-chk
4019 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 yes | no | yes | yes
4022 Arguments : none
4023
4024 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4025 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4026 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4027 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4028 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4029 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4030 hello message.
4031
4032 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4033 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4034 messages, which is appreciable.
4035
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004036 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4037 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4038 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004039
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004040 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4041
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004042
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004043option tcp-smart-accept
4044no option tcp-smart-accept
4045 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4047 yes | yes | yes | no
4048 Arguments : none
4049
4050 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4051 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4052 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4053 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4054 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4055 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4056
4057 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4058 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4059 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4060 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4061
4062 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4063 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4064 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4065 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4066
4067 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4068 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4069 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4070
4071 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4072 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4073 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4074
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004075 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4076
4077
4078option tcp-smart-connect
4079no option tcp-smart-connect
4080 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | no | yes | yes
4083 Arguments : none
4084
4085 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4086 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4087 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4088 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4089 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4090
4091 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4092 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4093 complex.
4094
4095 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4096 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4097 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4098
4099 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4100 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4101
4102 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4103
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004104
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004105option tcpka
4106 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4108 yes | yes | yes | yes
4109 Arguments : none
4110
4111 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4112 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4113 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4114 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4115
4116 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4117 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4118 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4119 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4120
4121 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4122 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4123 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4124 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4125 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4126
4127 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4128
4129 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4130 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4131 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4132 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4133 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4134 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4135 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4136 backends.
4137
4138 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4139
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004140
4141option tcplog
4142 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4144 yes | yes | yes | yes
4145 Arguments : none
4146
4147 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4148 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4149 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4150 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4151 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4152 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4153 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4154 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4155
4156 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004158 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004159
4160
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004161option transparent
4162no option transparent
4163 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004165 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004166 Arguments : none
4167
4168 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4169 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4170 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4171 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4172 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4173 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4174 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4175 appropriate server.
4176
4177 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4178 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4179
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004180 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004181 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004182
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004183
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004184persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004185persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004186 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4188 yes | no | yes | yes
4189 Arguments :
4190 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004191 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4192 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004193
4194 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4195 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4196 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4197 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4198 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4199 forwarded to this server.
4200
4201 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4202 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4203 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004204 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004205 a single "listen" section.
4206
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004207 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4208 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4209 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4210
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004211 Example :
4212 listen tse-farm
4213 bind :3389
4214 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4215 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4216 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4217 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4218 persist rdp-cookie
4219 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004220 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004221 balance rdp-cookie
4222 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4223 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4224
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004225 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4226 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004227
4228
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004229rate-limit sessions <rate>
4230 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 yes | yes | yes | no
4233 Arguments :
4234 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4235 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4236
4237 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4238 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4239 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4240 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4241 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4242 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4243
4244 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4245 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4246 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4247 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4248
4249 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4250 listen smtp
4251 mode tcp
4252 bind :25
4253 rate-limit sessions 10
4254 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4255
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004256 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4257 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4258 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004259
4260 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4261
4262
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004263redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4264redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4265redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004266 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 no | yes | yes | yes
4269
4270 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004271 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004272
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004273 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004274 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4275 the HTTP "Location" header.
4276
4277 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4278 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4279 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4280 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4281 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4282 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4283
4284 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4285 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4286 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4287 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4288 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4289 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4290 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4291 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4292 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004293
4294 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4295 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4296 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4297 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4298 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4299 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4300 location with a GET method.
4301
4302 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4303 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4304
4305 - "drop-query"
4306 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4307 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4308 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4309 with a location-type redirect.
4310
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004311 - "append-slash"
4312 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4313 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4314 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4315 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4316
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004317 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4318 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4319 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4320 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4321 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4322 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4323 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4324
4325 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4326 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4327 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4328 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4329 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4330 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4331 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004332
4333 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4334 acl clear dst_port 80
4335 acl secure dst_port 8080
4336 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004337 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004338 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004339 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4340
4341 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004342 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4343 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4344 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004345 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004346
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004347 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4348 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4349 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4350
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004351 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
4352 redirect scheme https if !{ is_ssl }
4353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004354 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004355
4356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004357redisp (deprecated)
4358redispatch (deprecated)
4359 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004362 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004363
4364 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4365 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4366 be able to access the service anymore.
4367
4368 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4369 redistribute them to a working server.
4370
4371 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4372 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4373 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004375 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4376 "option redispatch" instead.
4377
4378 See also : "option redispatch"
4379
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004380
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004381reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004382 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 no | yes | yes | yes
4385 Arguments :
4386 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4387 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004388 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004389
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004390 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4391 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4392
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4394 the last header of an HTTP request.
4395
4396 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4397 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4398 responses.
4399
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004400 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4401 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4402 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4403
4404 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4405 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004406
4407
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004408reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4409reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004410 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4412 no | yes | yes | yes
4413 Arguments :
4414 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4415 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4416 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4417 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4418 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4419 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4420 ignores case.
4421
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004422 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4423 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4424
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004425 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4426 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4427 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4428 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004429 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004430
4431 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4432 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4433
4434 Example :
4435 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4436 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4437 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4438
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004439 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4440 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004441
4442
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004443reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4444reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004445 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4447 no | yes | yes | yes
4448 Arguments :
4449 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4450 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4451 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4452 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4453 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4454 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004456 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4457 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4458
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004459 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4460 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4461 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4462 next servers.
4463
4464 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4465 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4466 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4467
4468 Example :
4469 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4470 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4471 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4472
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004473 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4474 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004475
4476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004477reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4478reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004479 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 no | yes | yes | yes
4482 Arguments :
4483 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4484 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4485 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4486 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4487 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4488 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4489 case.
4490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004491 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4492 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4493
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004494 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4495 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4496 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4497 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004498 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004499
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004500 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004501 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004502 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004503
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004504 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4505 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4506
4507 Example :
4508 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4509 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4510 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4511
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004512 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4513 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004514
4515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004516reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4517reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004518 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4520 no | yes | yes | yes
4521 Arguments :
4522 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4523 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4524 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4525 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4526 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4527 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4528 case.
4529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004530 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4531 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4532
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004533 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4534 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4535 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4536 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4537
4538 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4539 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4540
4541 Example :
4542 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4543 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4544 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4545 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4546
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004547 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4548 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004549
4550
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004551reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4552reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004553 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4555 no | yes | yes | yes
4556 Arguments :
4557 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4558 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4559 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4560 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4561 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4562 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4563
4564 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4565 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4566 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4567 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004568 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004569
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004570 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4571 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4572
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004573 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4574 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4575 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4576
4577 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4578 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4579 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4580 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4581 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4582
4583 Example :
4584 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004585 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4587 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4588
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004589 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4590 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004591
4592
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004593reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4594reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004595 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 no | yes | yes | yes
4598 Arguments :
4599 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4600 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4601 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4602 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4603 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4604 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4605 ignores case.
4606
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004607 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4608 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4609
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004610 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4611 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004612 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4613 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4614 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004615 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4616 not set.
4617
4618 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4619 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4620 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4621 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4622 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4623
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004624 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004625 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4626 # block all others.
4627 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4628 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4629
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004630 # block bad guys
4631 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4632 reqitarpit . if badguys
4633
4634 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4635 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004636
4637
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004638retries <value>
4639 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | no | yes | yes
4642 Arguments :
4643 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4644 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4645 default value is 3.
4646
4647 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4648 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4649 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4650
4651 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4652 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4653
4654 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4655 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4656
4657 See also : "option redispatch"
4658
4659
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004660rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004661 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4663 no | yes | yes | yes
4664 Arguments :
4665 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4666 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004667 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004669 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4670 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4671
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004672 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4673 the last header of an HTTP response.
4674
4675 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4676 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4677 responses.
4678
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004679 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4680 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681
4682
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004683rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4684rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 no | yes | yes | yes
4688 Arguments :
4689 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4690 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4691 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4692 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4693 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4694 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4695 ignores case.
4696
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004700 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4701 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004702 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004703 client.
4704
4705 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4706 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4707 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4708
4709 Example :
4710 # remove the Server header from responses
4711 reqidel ^Server:.*
4712
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004713 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4714 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004715
4716
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004717rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4718rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004719 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4721 no | yes | yes | yes
4722 Arguments :
4723 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4724 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4725 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4726 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4727 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4728 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4729 ignores case.
4730
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004731 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4732 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4733
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004734 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4735 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4736 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4737 case-sensitive.
4738
4739 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004740 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4741 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4742 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004743
4744 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4745 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4746
4747 Example :
4748 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4749 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4750
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004751 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4752 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004753
4754
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004755rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4756rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004757 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 no | yes | yes | yes
4760 Arguments :
4761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4762 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4763 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4764 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4765 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4766 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4767 ignores case.
4768
4769 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4770 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4771 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4772 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004773 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004774
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004775 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4776 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4777
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004778 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4779 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4780 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4781
4782 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4783 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4784 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4785 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4786 are not case-sensitive.
4787
4788 Example :
4789 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4790 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4791
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004792 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4793 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004794
4795
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004796server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004797 Declare a server in a backend
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 no | no | yes | yes
4800 Arguments :
4801 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004802 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004803 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004804
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004805 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4806 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4807 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4808 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004809 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4810 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4811 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4812 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4813 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4814 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004815
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004816 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004817 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4818 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4819 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4820 adding this value to the client's port.
4821
4822 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4823 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004824 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004825
4826 Examples :
4827 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4828 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4829
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004830 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4831 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004832
4833
4834source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004835source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004836source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004837 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4839 yes | no | yes | yes
4840 Arguments :
4841 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4842 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4843 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4844 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4845
4846 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4847 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004848 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4849 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4850 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004851
4852 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4853 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4854 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4855 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4856 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4857 <addr>.
4858
4859 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4860 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4861 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4862 port.
4863
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004864 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4865 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4866 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4867 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4868 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4869 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4870 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4871 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4872 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4873 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4874 HTTP header.
4875
4876 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4877 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004878 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004879 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4880 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4881 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4882 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4883 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4884 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4885 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4886
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004887 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4888 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4889 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4890 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4891 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4892 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4893
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004894 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4895 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4896 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4897 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4898
4899 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4900 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4901 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4902 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4903 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4904 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4905
4906 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4907 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4908 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4909 there are two methods :
4910
4911 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4912 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4913 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4914 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4915 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4916 of the client ranges may be used.
4917
4918 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4919 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4920 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4921 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4922 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4923 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4924 same session.
4925
4926 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4927 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4928 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4929 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4930 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4931 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4932
4933 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4934 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4935 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004936 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004937
4938 Examples :
4939 backend private
4940 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4941 source 192.168.1.200
4942
4943 backend transparent_ssl1
4944 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4945 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4946
4947 backend transparent_ssl2
4948 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4949 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4950 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4951
4952 backend transparent_ssl3
4953 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4954 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4955 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4956
4957 backend transparent_smtp
4958 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4959 # with Tproxy version 4.
4960 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4961
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004962 backend transparent_http
4963 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4964 # proxy.
4965 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004967 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004968 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004970
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004971srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4972 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | no | yes | yes
4975 Arguments :
4976 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4977 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4978 as explained at the top of this document.
4979
4980 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4981 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4982 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4983 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4984 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4985 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4986 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4987
4988 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4989 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4990 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4991 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4992 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004993 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004994 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004995 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004996
4997 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4998 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4999 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5000 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5001 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5002 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5003
5004 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5005 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5006
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005007 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5008 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005009
5010
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005011stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5012 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5014 no | no | yes | yes
5015
5016 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5017 matched.
5018
5019 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5020 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5021
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005022 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5023 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5024 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5025
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005026 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5027 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5028 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5029 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005030
5031 Example :
5032 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5033 backend stats_localhost
5034 stats enable
5035 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5036
5037 Example :
5038 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5039 backend stats_auth
5040 stats enable
5041 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5042 stats admin if TRUE
5043
5044 Example :
5045 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5046 userlist stats-auth
5047 group admin users admin
5048 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5049 group readonly users haproxy
5050 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5051
5052 backend stats_auth
5053 stats enable
5054 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5055 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5056 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5057 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5058
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005059 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5060 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5061 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005062
5063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005064stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5065 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | no | yes | yes
5068 Arguments :
5069 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5070
5071 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5072
5073 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5074 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5075 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5076 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5077 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5078 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5079
5080 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5081 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5082 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005083 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005084
5085 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5086 report using "stats scope".
5087
5088 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5089 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5090 unobvious parameters.
5091
5092 Example :
5093 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5094 backend public_www
5095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5096 stats enable
5097 stats hide-version
5098 stats scope .
5099 stats uri /admin?stats
5100 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5101 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5102 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5103
5104 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5105 backend private_monitoring
5106 stats enable
5107 stats uri /admin?stats
5108 stats refresh 5s
5109
5110 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5111
5112
5113stats enable
5114 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117 Arguments : none
5118
5119 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5120 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5121 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5122 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5123 - stats auth : no authentication
5124 - stats scope : no restriction
5125
5126 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5127 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5128 unobvious parameters.
5129
5130 Example :
5131 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5132 backend public_www
5133 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5134 stats enable
5135 stats hide-version
5136 stats scope .
5137 stats uri /admin?stats
5138 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5139 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5140 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5141
5142 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5143 backend private_monitoring
5144 stats enable
5145 stats uri /admin?stats
5146 stats refresh 5s
5147
5148 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5149
5150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005151stats hide-version
5152 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005155 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005157 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5158 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5159 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5160 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5161 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5162 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005164 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5165 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5166 unobvious parameters.
5167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005168 Example :
5169 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5170 backend public_www
5171 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005172 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005173 stats hide-version
5174 stats scope .
5175 stats uri /admin?stats
5176 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5177 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5178 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005179
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005180 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5181 backend private_monitoring
5182 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005183 stats uri /admin?stats
5184 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005185
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005186 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005187
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005188
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005189stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5190 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5191 Access control for statistics
5192
5193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 no | no | yes | yes
5195
5196 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5197 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5198 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5199 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5200 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5201 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5202
5203 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5204 instance.
5205
5206 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5207 about ACL usage.
5208
5209
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005210stats realm <realm>
5211 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5213 yes | no | yes | yes
5214 Arguments :
5215 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5216 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5217 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5218
5219 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5220 using a backslash ('\').
5221
5222 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5223 only related to authentication.
5224
5225 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5226 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5227 unobvious parameters.
5228
5229 Example :
5230 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5231 backend public_www
5232 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5233 stats enable
5234 stats hide-version
5235 stats scope .
5236 stats uri /admin?stats
5237 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5238 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5239 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5240
5241 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5242 backend private_monitoring
5243 stats enable
5244 stats uri /admin?stats
5245 stats refresh 5s
5246
5247 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5248
5249
5250stats refresh <delay>
5251 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5253 yes | no | yes | yes
5254 Arguments :
5255 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5256 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5257 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5258 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5259 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5260 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5261
5262 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5263 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5264 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5265 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5266
5267 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5268 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5269 unobvious parameters.
5270
5271 Example :
5272 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5273 backend public_www
5274 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5275 stats enable
5276 stats hide-version
5277 stats scope .
5278 stats uri /admin?stats
5279 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5280 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5281 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5282
5283 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5284 backend private_monitoring
5285 stats enable
5286 stats uri /admin?stats
5287 stats refresh 5s
5288
5289 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5290
5291
5292stats scope { <name> | "." }
5293 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5295 yes | no | yes | yes
5296 Arguments :
5297 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5298 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5299 section in which the statement appears.
5300
5301 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5302 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5303 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5304 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5305 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5306 exists.
5307
5308 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5309 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5310 unobvious parameters.
5311
5312 Example :
5313 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5314 backend public_www
5315 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5316 stats enable
5317 stats hide-version
5318 stats scope .
5319 stats uri /admin?stats
5320 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5321 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5322 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5323
5324 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5325 backend private_monitoring
5326 stats enable
5327 stats uri /admin?stats
5328 stats refresh 5s
5329
5330 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5331
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005332
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005333stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005334 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5336 yes | no | yes | yes
5337
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005338 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005339 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5340
5341 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5342 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5343
5344 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5345 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005346 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005347
5348 Example :
5349 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5350 backend private_monitoring
5351 stats enable
5352 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5353 stats uri /admin?stats
5354 stats refresh 5s
5355
5356 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5357 global section.
5358
5359
5360stats show-legends
5361 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5362 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5363 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5364 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5365 - IP (socket, server)
5366 - cookie (backend, server)
5367
5368 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5369 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005370 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005371
5372 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5373
5374
5375stats show-node [ <name> ]
5376 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | no | yes | yes
5379 Arguments:
5380 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5381 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5382
5383 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5384 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005385 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005386
5387 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5388 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5389 unobvious parameters.
5390
5391 Example:
5392 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5393 backend private_monitoring
5394 stats enable
5395 stats show-node Europe-1
5396 stats uri /admin?stats
5397 stats refresh 5s
5398
5399 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5400 section.
5401
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005402
5403stats uri <prefix>
5404 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | yes | yes
5407 Arguments :
5408 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5409 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5410 query string.
5411
5412 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5413 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5414 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5415 possible to reach it in the application.
5416
5417 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005418 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005419 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5420 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5421 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5422 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5423
5424 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5425 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5426 an address or a port to statistics only.
5427
5428 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5429 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5430 unobvious parameters.
5431
5432 Example :
5433 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5434 backend public_www
5435 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5436 stats enable
5437 stats hide-version
5438 stats scope .
5439 stats uri /admin?stats
5440 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5441 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5442 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5443
5444 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5445 backend private_monitoring
5446 stats enable
5447 stats uri /admin?stats
5448 stats refresh 5s
5449
5450 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5451
5452
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005453stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5454 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005456 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005457
5458 Arguments :
5459 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5460 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5461 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5462 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5463
5464 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5465 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5466 the "stick-table" statement.
5467
5468 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5469 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5470 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5471 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5472 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5473
5474 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5475 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5476 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5477 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5478 transformation rules.
5479
5480 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5481 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5482 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5483 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5484 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5485 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5486 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5487
5488 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5489 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5490 ACL based conditions.
5491
5492 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5493 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5494 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5495 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5496
5497 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5498 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5499 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5500 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5501
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005502 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5503 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5504 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5505
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005506 Example :
5507 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5508 # last 30 minutes
5509 backend pop
5510 mode tcp
5511 balance roundrobin
5512 stick store-request src
5513 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5514 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5515 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5516
5517 backend smtp
5518 mode tcp
5519 balance roundrobin
5520 stick match src table pop
5521 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5522 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5523
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005524 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5525 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005526
5527
5528stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5529 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 no | no | yes | yes
5532
5533 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5534 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5535 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5536 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5537
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005538 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5539 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5540 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5541
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005542 Examples :
5543 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005544 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005545
5546 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5547 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5548 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5549
5550
5551 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5552 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5553 backend http
5554 mode http
5555 balance roundrobin
5556 stick on src table https
5557 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5558 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5559 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5560
5561 backend https
5562 mode tcp
5563 balance roundrobin
5564 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5565 stick on src
5566 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5567 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005569 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005570
5571
5572stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5573 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 no | no | yes | yes
5576
5577 Arguments :
5578 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5579 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5580 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5581 server is selected.
5582
5583 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5584 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5585 the "stick-table" statement.
5586
5587 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5588 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5589 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5590 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5591 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5592 address.
5593
5594 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5595 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5596 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5597 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5598 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5599 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5600 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5601 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5602 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5603 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5604
5605 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5606 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5607 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5608 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5609 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5610 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5611 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5612
5613 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5614 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5615 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5616 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5617
5618 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5619 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5620 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5621 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5622 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5623 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5624 another protocol or access method.
5625
5626 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5627 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5628 the request.
5629
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005630 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5631 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5632 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5633
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005634 Example :
5635 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5636 # last 30 minutes
5637 backend pop
5638 mode tcp
5639 balance roundrobin
5640 stick store-request src
5641 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5642 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5643 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5644
5645 backend smtp
5646 mode tcp
5647 balance roundrobin
5648 stick match src table pop
5649 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5650 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005652 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5653 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005654
5655
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005656stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005657 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5658 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005659 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005661 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005662
5663 Arguments :
5664 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5665 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5666 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5667 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5668
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005669 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5670 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5671 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5672 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5673
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005674 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5675 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5676 instance.
5677
5678 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5679 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5680 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5681 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5682 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5683 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005684 to 32 characters.
5685
5686 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5687 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5688 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5689 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5690 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5691 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005692
5693 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005694 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5695 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005696 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5697 increase.
5698
5699 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005700 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5701 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5702 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005703
5704 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5705 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5706 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5707 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5708 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5709 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5710 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5711 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5712 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5713 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5714 parameter (see below).
5715
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005716 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5717 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5718 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5719 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5720 soft restart.
5721
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005722 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5723
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005724 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5725 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5726 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5727 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5728 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005729 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005730 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5731 if not expiration delay is specified.
5732
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005733 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5734 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5735 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5736 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005737 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5738 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5739 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5740 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5741 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5742 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5743 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5744 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5745 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5746 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5747 types and their arguments.
5748
5749 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5750 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5751 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5752 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5753
5754 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5755 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5756 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5757 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5758
5759 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5760 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5761 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5762 they were received.
5763
5764 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5765 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5766 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5767 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5768 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5769
5770 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5771 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5772 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5773 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5774 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5775
5776 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5777 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5778 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5779
5780 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5781 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5782 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5783 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5784 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5785
5786 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5787 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5788 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5789 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5790 the client side.
5791
5792 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5793 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5794 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5795 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5796 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5797 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5798 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5799
5800 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5801 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5802 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5803 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5804 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5805 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5806 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5807
5808 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5809 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5810 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5811 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5812 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5813 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5814
5815 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5816 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5817 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5818 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5819
5820 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5821 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5822 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5823 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5824 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5825 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5826 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5827 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5828 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5829 recommended for better fairness.
5830
5831 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5832 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5833 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5834 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5835
5836 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5837 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5838 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5839 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5840 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5841 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5842 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5843 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5844 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5845 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005846
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005847 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5848 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005849 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5850 reference it.
5851
5852 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5853 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5854 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5855 as an exclusive stickiness.
5856
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005857 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5858 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5859 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5860 something that can be ignored.
5861
5862 Example:
5863 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5864 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5865 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5866 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5867
5868 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005869 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005870
5871
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005872stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5873 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5875 no | no | yes | yes
5876
5877 Arguments :
5878 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5879 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5880 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5881 server is selected.
5882
5883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5885 the "stick-table" statement.
5886
5887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5889 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5890 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5891
5892 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5893 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5894 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5895 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5896 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5897 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005898 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005899 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5900 rules.
5901
5902 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5903 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5904 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5905 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5906 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5907 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5908 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5909
5910 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5911 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5912 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5913 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5914
5915 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5916 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5917 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5918 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5919 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5920 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5921 another protocol or access method.
5922
5923 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5924
5925 Example :
5926 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5927 backend https
5928 mode tcp
5929 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005930 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005931 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005932
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005933 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5934 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5935
5936 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5937 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5938 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5939
5940 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5941 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005942
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005943 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5944 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5945 # at offset 44.
5946
5947 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5948 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5949
5950 # Learn on response if server hello.
5951 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005952
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005953 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5954 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5955
5956 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5957 extraction.
5958
5959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005960tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5961 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5963 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005964 Arguments :
5965 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5966 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5967 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005969 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005970
5971 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5972 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5974 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5975 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5976 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5977 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5978 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005979
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005980 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5981 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5982 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5983 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005984
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005985 Three types of actions are supported :
5986 - accept :
5987 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5988 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5989 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005990
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005991 - reject :
5992 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5993 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5994 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5995 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5996 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5997 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5998 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5999 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6000 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6001 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6002 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6003 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006005 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6006 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6007 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6008 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6009 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6010 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6011 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6012 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6013 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006015 These actions take one or two arguments :
6016 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6017 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6018 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006020 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6021 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6022 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6023 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006025 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6026 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6027 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6028 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6029 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6030 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6031 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6032 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6033 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6034 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006036 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6037 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6038 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006039
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006040 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6041 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6042 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006044 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006045 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006046 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6049 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6050 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6053 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6054 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006055
6056 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006059
6060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006061tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6062 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006064 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006065 Arguments :
6066 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6067 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6068 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006069
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006070 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006072 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6073 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6074 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6075 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6076 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6079 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6080 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6081 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6082 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6083 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6084 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6085 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6086 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006088 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6089 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6090 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6091 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093 Three types of actions are supported :
6094 - accept :
6095 - reject :
6096 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006098 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6099 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6102 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6103 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6104 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6105 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6106 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006108 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6110 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006112 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006113 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6114 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6115 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6116 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6117 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006118
6119 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6121 # and reject everything else.
6122 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6123 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006124 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 tcp-request content reject
6126
6127 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006128 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6129 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6130 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006131 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006132
6133 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6134 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6135 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006136 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006137 tcp-request content reject
6138
6139 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6140 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6141
6142 frontend http
6143 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6144 # protecting all our sites
6145 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6146 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6147 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6148 ...
6149 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6150
6151 backend http_dynamic
6152 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6153 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6154 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6155 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6156 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6157 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6158 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006160 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006162 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006163
6164
6165tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6166 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006168 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006169 Arguments :
6170 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6172 as explained at the top of this document.
6173
6174 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6175 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6176 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6177 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6178 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6179
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006180 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6181 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6182 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6183 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6184
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006185 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6186 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006187 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006188 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006189 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6190 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6191 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6192 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006193
6194 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6195 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6196 it pass through unaffected.
6197
6198 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6199 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6200 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006201 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006202 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6203 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006204 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6205 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6206 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006207
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006208 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006209 "timeout client".
6210
6211
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006212tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6213 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 no | no | yes | yes
6216 Arguments :
6217 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6218 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6219 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6220
6221 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6222
6223 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6224 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6225 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6226 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006227 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006228
6229 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6230
6231 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6232 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6233 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6234 inserted.
6235
6236 Two types of actions are supported :
6237 - accept :
6238 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6239 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6240 the rules evaluation.
6241
6242 - reject :
6243 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6244 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006245 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006246
6247 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6248 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6249 for changing the default action to a reject.
6250
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006251 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6252 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6253 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6254 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006255 period.
6256
6257 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6258
6259 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6260
6261
6262tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6263 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6265 no | no | yes | yes
6266 Arguments :
6267 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6269 as explained at the top of this document.
6270
6271 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6272
6273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006274timeout check <timeout>
6275 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6276 established.
6277
6278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | no | yes | yes
6280 Arguments:
6281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6283 as explained at the top of this document.
6284
6285 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6286 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6287 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6288 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006289 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6290 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6291 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006292
6293 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6294 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6295
6296 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6297 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006298 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006299
6300 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6301 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6302 forget about it.
6303
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006304 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6305 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006306
6307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006308timeout client <timeout>
6309timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6310 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6312 yes | yes | yes | no
6313 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006314 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006315 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6316 as explained at the top of this document.
6317
6318 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6319 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6320 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6321 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6322 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6323 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6324 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6325 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006326 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006327 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006328 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6329 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6330 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006331
6332 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6333 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6334 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6335 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6336 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6337 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6338
6339 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6340 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6341 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6342
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006343 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006344
6345
6346timeout connect <timeout>
6347timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6348 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6350 yes | no | yes | yes
6351 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006352 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006353 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6354 as explained at the top of this document.
6355
6356 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006357 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006358 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006359 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006360 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6361 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006362
6363 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6364 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6365 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6366 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6367 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6368 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6369
6370 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6371 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6372 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6373
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006374 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6375 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006376
6377
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006378timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6379 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 yes | yes | yes | yes
6382 Arguments :
6383 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6384 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6385 as explained at the top of this document.
6386
6387 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6388 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6389 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6390 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6391 once the request has started to present itself.
6392
6393 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6394 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6395 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6396 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6397 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6398
6399 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6400 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6401 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6402 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6403
6404 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6405 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6406 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6407 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6408 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006409 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006410
6411 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6412 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6413 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6414 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6415
6416 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6417
6418
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006419timeout http-request <timeout>
6420 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006422 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006423 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006424 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006425 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6426 as explained at the top of this document.
6427
6428 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6429 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6430 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6431 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6432 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6433 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6434 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6435 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6436
6437 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6438 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006439 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6440 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006441
6442 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6443 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6444 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6445 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6446 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6447
6448 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006449 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6450 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6451 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006452
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006453 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006454
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006455
6456timeout queue <timeout>
6457 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | no | yes | yes
6460 Arguments :
6461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6463 as explained at the top of this document.
6464
6465 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6466 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6467 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6468 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6469 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6470
6471 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6472 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6473 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6474 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6475
6476 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6477
6478
6479timeout server <timeout>
6480timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6481 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | no | yes | yes
6484 Arguments :
6485 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6486 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6487 as explained at the top of this document.
6488
6489 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6490 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6491 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6492 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6493 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6494 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6495 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6496
6497 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6498 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6499 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6500 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6501 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006502 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006503 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006504 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6505 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6506 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6507 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006508
6509 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6510 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6511 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6512 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6513 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6514 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6515
6516 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6517 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6518 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6519
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006520 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006521
6522
6523timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006524 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6526 yes | yes | yes | yes
6527 Arguments :
6528 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6529 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6530 as explained at the top of this document.
6531
6532 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6533 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6534 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6535
6536 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6537 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6538 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6539 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006540 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006541
6542 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6543
6544
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006545timeout tunnel <timeout>
6546 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6548 yes | no | yes | yes
6549 Arguments :
6550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6552 as explained at the top of this document.
6553
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006554 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006555 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6556 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6557 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6558 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6559 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6560 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6561 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6562 specified.
6563
6564 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6565 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6566 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6567 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6568 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6569
6570 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6571 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6572 forget about it.
6573
6574 Example :
6575 defaults http
6576 option http-server-close
6577 timeout connect 5s
6578 timeout client 30s
6579 timeout client 30s
6580 timeout server 30s
6581 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6582
6583 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6584
6585
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006586transparent (deprecated)
6587 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006589 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006590 Arguments : none
6591
6592 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6593 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6594 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6595 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6596 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6597 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6598 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6599 appropriate server.
6600
6601 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6602
6603 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6604 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6605
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006606 See also: "option transparent"
6607
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006608unique-id-format <string>
6609 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6611 yes | yes | yes | no
6612 Arguments :
6613 <string> is a log-format string.
6614
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006615 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6616 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6617 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6618 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006619
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006620 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6621 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6622 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6623 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6624 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6625 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6626 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6627 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006628
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006629 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6630 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006631
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006632 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006633
6634 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6635
6636 will generate:
6637
6638 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6639
6640 See also: "unique-id-header"
6641
6642unique-id-header <name>
6643 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6645 yes | yes | yes | no
6646 Arguments :
6647 <name> is the name of the header.
6648
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006649 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6650 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006651
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006652 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006653
6654 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6655 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6656
6657 will generate:
6658
6659 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6660
6661 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006662
6663use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6664use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006665 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 no | yes | yes | no
6668 Arguments :
6669 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006671 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006672
6673 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6674 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6675 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006676 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6677 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6678 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6679 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006680
6681 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6682 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6683 assign the backend.
6684
6685 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6686 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6687 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6688 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6689 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6690 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6691
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006692 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006693 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006694 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6695 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6696 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6697
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006698 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006699
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006700
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006701use-server <server> if <condition>
6702use-server <server> unless <condition>
6703 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6705 no | no | yes | yes
6706 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006707 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006708
6709 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6710
6711 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6712 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6713 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6714
6715 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6716 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6717 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6718 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6719 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6720 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6721 matches will assign the server.
6722
6723 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6724 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6725 with the next rules until one matches.
6726
6727 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6728 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6729 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6730 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6731
6732 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6733 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6734 stripped.
6735
6736 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6737 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6738 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6739 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6740
6741 Example :
6742 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6743 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6744 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6745 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6746 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6747 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6748 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6749 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6750 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6751
6752 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6753
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006754
67555. Bind and Server options
6756--------------------------
6757
6758The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6759depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6760settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6761written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6762described in this section.
6763
6764
67655.1. Bind options
6766-----------------
6767
6768The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6769as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6770no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6771parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6772while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6773provided immediately after the setting name.
6774
6775The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6776
6777accept-proxy
6778 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6779 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6780 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6781 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6782 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6783 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6784 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6785 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6786 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6787 usable.
6788
6789backlog <backlog>
6790 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6791 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6792
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006793ecdhe <named curve>
6794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6795 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6796 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6797
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006798ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006799 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6800 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6801 client's certificate.
6802
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006803ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6805 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6806 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6807 error is ignored.
6808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006809ciphers <ciphers>
6810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6811 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6812 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6813 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6814 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6815
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006816crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6818 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6819 to verify client's certificate.
6820
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006821crt <cert>
6822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6823 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6824 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006825 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6826 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6827 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6828 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6829 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6830 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6831 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6832 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006833 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006834 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6835 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6836 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6837 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6838 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006839
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006840crt-ignore-err <errors>
6841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6842 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6843 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6844 error is ignored.
6845
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006846defer-accept
6847 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6848 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6849 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6850 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6851 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6852 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6853 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6854 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6855 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6856 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6857 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6858
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006859force-sslv3
6860 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6861 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6862 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6863
6864force-tlsv10
6865 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6866 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6867
6868force-tlsv11
6869 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6870 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6871
6872force-tlsv12
6873 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6874 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6875
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006876gid <gid>
6877 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6878 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6879 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6880 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6881 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6882
6883group <group>
6884 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6885 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6886 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6887 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6888 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6889
6890id <id>
6891 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6892 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6893 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6894 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6895
6896interface <interface>
6897 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6898 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6899 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6900 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6901 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6902 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6903 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6904 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6905
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006906level <level>
6907 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6908 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6909 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6910 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6911 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6912 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6913 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6914 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6915 counters).
6916 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6917 all counters).
6918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006919maxconn <maxconn>
6920 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6921 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6922 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6923 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6924 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6925 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6926 eat all memory.
6927
6928mode <mode>
6929 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6930 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6931 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6932 UNIX sockets.
6933
6934mss <maxseg>
6935 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6936 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6937 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6938 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6939 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6940 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6941 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6942 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6943 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6944 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6945 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6946
6947name <name>
6948 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
6949 page.
6950
6951nice <nice>
6952 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
6953 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
6954 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
6955 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
6956 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
6957 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
6958 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
6959 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
6960 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
6961 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
6962 one for an RDP socket.
6963
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006964no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006965 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6966 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
6967 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006968 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6969 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006970
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02006971no-tls-tickets
6972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6973 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
6974 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
6975 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
6976
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006977no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006979 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6980 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6981 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6982 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006983
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006984no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006986 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6987 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6988 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6989 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006990
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02006991no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006993 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
6994 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
6995 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
6996 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02006997
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02006998npn <protocols>
6999 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7000 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7001 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7002 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7003 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7004
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007005ssl
7006 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7007 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7008 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7009 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7010 to deciphered contents.
7011
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007012tfo
7013 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7014 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7015 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7016 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7017 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7018 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7019 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7020 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7021 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7022
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007023transparent
7024 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7025 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7026 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7027 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7028 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7029 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7030 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7031 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7032 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7033 so check for support with your vendor.
7034
7035uid <uid>
7036 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7037 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7038 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7039 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7040 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7041
7042user <user>
7043 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7044 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7045 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7046 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7047 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7048
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007049verify [none|optional|required]
7050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7051 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7052 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7053 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7054 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007055 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7056 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7057 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7058 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020070605.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007061------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007063The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7064which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7065arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7066settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7067after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7068Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7069address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007071 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007072 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007074The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007075
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007076addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007077 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7078 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7079 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7080 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7081 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007082
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007083 Supported in default-server: No
7084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007085backup
7086 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7087 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7088 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7089 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7090 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7091 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007093 Supported in default-server: No
7094
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007095ca-file <cafile>
7096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7097 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7098 server's certificate.
7099
7100 Supported in default-server: No
7101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007102check
7103 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007104 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7105 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7106 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7107 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7108 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7109 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7110 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7111 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7112 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7113 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007115 Supported in default-server: No
7116
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007117check-send-proxy
7118 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7119 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7120 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7121 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7122 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7123 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7124 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7125
7126 Supported in default-server: No
7127
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007128check-ssl
7129 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7130 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7131 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7132 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7133 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7134 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7135 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7136 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7137 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7138
7139 Supported in default-server: No
7140
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007141ciphers <ciphers>
7142 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7143 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7144 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7145 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7146 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7147 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7148 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7149 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7150
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007151 Supported in default-server: No
7152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007153cookie <value>
7154 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7155 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7156 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7157 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7158 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7159 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7160 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007162 Supported in default-server: No
7163
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007164crl-file <crlfile>
7165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7166 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7167 to verify server's certificate.
7168
7169 Supported in default-server: No
7170
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007171crt <cert>
7172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7173 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7174 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7175 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7176 certificate request.
7177
7178 Supported in default-server: No
7179
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007180disabled
7181 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7182 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7183 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7184 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7185 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7186
7187 Supported in default-server: No
7188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007189error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007190 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7191 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7192 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007193
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007194 Supported in default-server: Yes
7195
7196 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007198fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007199 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7200 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7201 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007203 Supported in default-server: Yes
7204
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007205force-sslv3
7206 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7207 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7208 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7209
7210 Supported in default-server: No
7211
7212force-tlsv10
7213 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7214 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7215
7216 Supported in default-server: No
7217
7218force-tlsv11
7219 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7220 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7221
7222 Supported in default-server: No
7223
7224force-tlsv12
7225 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7226 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7227
7228 Supported in default-server: No
7229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007230id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007231 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7232 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7233 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007235 Supported in default-server: No
7236
7237inter <delay>
7238fastinter <delay>
7239downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007240 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7241 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7242 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7243 between checks depending on the server state :
7244
7245 Server state | Interval used
7246 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7247 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7248 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7249 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7250 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7251 or yet unchecked. |
7252 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7253 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7254 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007256 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7257 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7258 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7259 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7260 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7261 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7262 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7263 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7264 servers.
7265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007266 Supported in default-server: Yes
7267
7268maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007269 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7270 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7271 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7272 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7273 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7274 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7275 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7276 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007278 Supported in default-server: Yes
7279
7280maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007281 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7282 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7283 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7284 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7285 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7286 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7287 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007289 Supported in default-server: Yes
7290
7291minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007292 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7293 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7294 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7295 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7296 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7297 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007298 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007299 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007301 Supported in default-server: Yes
7302
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007303no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007304 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7305 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007306 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007307
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007308 Supported in default-server: No
7309
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007310no-tls-tickets
7311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7312 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7313 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7314 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7315
7316 Supported in default-server: No
7317
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007318no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007319 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007320 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7321 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007322 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7323 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007324
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007325 Supported in default-server: No
7326
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007327no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007328 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007329 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7330 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007331 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7332 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007333
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007334 Supported in default-server: No
7335
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007336no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007337 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007338 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7339 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007340 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7341 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007342
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007343 Supported in default-server: No
7344
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007345non-stick
7346 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7347 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7348 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7349
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007350 Supported in default-server: No
7351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007352observe <mode>
7353 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7354 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7355 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7356 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7357 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7358 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007359 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007361 Supported in default-server: No
7362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007363 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007365on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007366 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7367 Currently, four modes are available:
7368 - fastinter: force fastinter
7369 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7370 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7371 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7372 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007374 Supported in default-server: Yes
7375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007376 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7377
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007378on-marked-down <action>
7379 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7380 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007381 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7382 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7383 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7384 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7385 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7386 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7387 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7388 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007389
7390 Actions are disabled by default
7391
7392 Supported in default-server: Yes
7393
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007394on-marked-up <action>
7395 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7396 Currently one action is available:
7397 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7398 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7399 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7400 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7401 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7402 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7403 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7404 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7405
7406 Actions are disabled by default
7407
7408 Supported in default-server: Yes
7409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007410port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007411 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7412 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7413 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7414 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7415 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7416 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007418 Supported in default-server: Yes
7419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007420redir <prefix>
7421 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7422 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7423 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7424 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7425 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7426 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7427 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7428 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007429 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007430 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7431 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7432 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7433 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7434 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7435
7436 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007438 Supported in default-server: No
7439
7440rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007441 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7442 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7443 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007445 Supported in default-server: Yes
7446
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007447send-proxy
7448 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7449 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7450 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7451 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7452 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7453 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7454 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7455 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7456 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007457 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7458 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7459 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7460 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7461 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007462
7463 Supported in default-server: No
7464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007465slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007466 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7467 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7468 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7469 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7470 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7471 parameters :
7472
7473 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7474 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7475
7476 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7477 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7478 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7479 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7480
7481 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7482 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7483 seen as failed.
7484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007485 Supported in default-server: Yes
7486
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007487source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007488source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007489source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007490 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7491 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7492 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7493 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7494
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007495 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7496 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7497 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7498 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7499 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7500 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7501 server.
7502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007503 Supported in default-server: No
7504
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007505ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007506 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7507 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7508 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7509 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7510 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7511 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7512 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7513 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7514
7515 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007517track [<proxy>/]<server>
7518 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7519 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7520 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7521 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7522 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7523
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007524 Supported in default-server: No
7525
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007526verify [none|required]
7527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7528 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7529 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7530 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7531 is aborted.
7532
7533 Supported in default-server: No
7534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007535weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007536 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7537 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7538 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007539 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7540 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7541 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7542 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7543 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7544 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007546 Supported in default-server: Yes
7547
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007548
75496. HTTP header manipulation
7550---------------------------
7551
7552In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7553response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7554request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7555which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7556against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7557to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7558passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7559headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7560never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7561
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007562There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7563(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7564rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7565messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7566in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007567happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007568add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7569normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007571This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7572in section 4.2 :
7573
7574 - reqadd <string>
7575 - reqallow <search>
7576 - reqiallow <search>
7577 - reqdel <search>
7578 - reqidel <search>
7579 - reqdeny <search>
7580 - reqideny <search>
7581 - reqpass <search>
7582 - reqipass <search>
7583 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7584 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7585 - reqtarpit <search>
7586 - reqitarpit <search>
7587 - rspadd <string>
7588 - rspdel <search>
7589 - rspidel <search>
7590 - rspdeny <search>
7591 - rspideny <search>
7592 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7593 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7594
7595With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7596is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7597parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7598prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7599Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7600
7601 \t for a tab
7602 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7603 \n for a new line (LF)
7604 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7605 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7606 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7607 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7608 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7609
7610The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7611portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7612above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7613regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76149 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7615is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7616
7617The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7618after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7619
7620Notes related to these keywords :
7621---------------------------------
7622 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7623 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7624 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7625
7626 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7627 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7628 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7629
7630 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7631 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7632 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7633 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7634 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7635
7636 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7637 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7638 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7639 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7640 useless headers before adding new ones.
7641
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007642 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007643 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7644
7645 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7646 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7647 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7648
7649 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7650 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007651 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007652
7653
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010076547. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7655------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007656
7657The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7658content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7659from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7660simple :
7661
7662 - define test criteria with sets of values
7663 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7664
7665The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7666
7667In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7668
7669 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7670
7671This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7672Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7673and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7674an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7675of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7676
7677ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7678'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7679which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7680
7681There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7682performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7683
7684The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7685
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007686 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7687 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007688 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7689
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007690The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7691specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7692possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007693multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7694be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7695needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7696space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7697match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7698lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7699duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007700to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007701instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007702
7703 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7704
7705In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7706the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7707case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7708too.
7709
7710Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7711a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7712ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7713
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007714Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007715
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007716 - integers or integer ranges
7717 - strings
7718 - regular expressions
7719 - IP addresses and networks
7720
7721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077227.1. Matching integers
7723----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007724
7725Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7726that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7727expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7728may be omitted.
7729
7730For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7731unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7732representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7733
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007734As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7735two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7736instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7737ranges and operators.
7738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007739For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007740operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7741Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7742of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007744Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007745
7746 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7747 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7748 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7749 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7750 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007752For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007753
7754 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7755
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007756This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7757
7758 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077617.2. Matching strings
7762---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007763
7764String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7765exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7766characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7767string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7768to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007769before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007770
7771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077727.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7773-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007774
7775Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7776they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7777possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7778passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7779the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007780the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7781match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007782
7783
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020077847.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007785----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007786
7787IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7788netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7789within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007790host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007791difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7792at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7793does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7794parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007795
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007796IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7797Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7798trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7799IPv6 patterns.
7800
7801HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7802following situations :
7803 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7804 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7805 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7806 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7807 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7808 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7809 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7810 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7811 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7812 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7813
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078157.5. Available matching criteria
7816--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078187.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7819------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007820
7821A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7822analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007823addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007824
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007825always_false
7826 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7827 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7828
7829always_true
7830 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7831 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7832
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007833avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007834avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007835 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7836 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7837 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7838 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7839 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7840 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7841 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7842 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7843 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7844 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7845 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007846
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007847be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007848be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007849 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7850 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7851 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7852 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7853 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007854
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007855be_id <integer>
7856 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7857 backend it was called.
7858
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007859be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007860be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007861 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7862 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7863 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7864 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7865 sucking of an online dictionary).
7866
7867 Example :
7868 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7869 backend dynamic
7870 mode http
7871 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7872 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007873
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007874connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007875connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007876 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007877 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007878 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7879
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007880 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7881 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007882
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007883 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007884 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7885 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7886 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7887 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7888 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007889 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007890
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007891 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7892 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7893 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7894 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007896dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007897 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7898 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007899
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007900dst_conn <integer>
7901 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7902 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7903 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7904 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7905 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7906 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7907
7908dst_port <integer>
7909 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7910 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7911
7912fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007913fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007914 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7915 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7916 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7917 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7918 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7919 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7920 criteria.
7921
7922fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007923 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007924 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007925
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007926fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007927fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007928 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7929 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7930 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7931 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7932 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7933 the rate to go down below the limit.
7934
7935 Example :
7936 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7937 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7938 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7939 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7940 frontend mail
7941 bind :25
7942 mode tcp
7943 maxconn 100
7944 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7945 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7946 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7947 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007949nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007950nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007951 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7952 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7953 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7954 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7955 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007956
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007957queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007958queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007959 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7960 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7961 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7962 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7963 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7964 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7965 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007967sc1_bytes_in_rate
7968sc2_bytes_in_rate
7969 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7970 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7971 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7972
7973sc1_bytes_out_rate
7974sc2_bytes_out_rate
7975 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7976 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7977 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7978
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007979sc1_clr_gpc0
7980sc2_clr_gpc0
7981 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7982 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7983 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7984 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7985 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7986 was verified :
7987
7988 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7989 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7990 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7991 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7992 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7993 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7994 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007996sc1_conn_cnt
7997sc2_conn_cnt
7998 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7999 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8000
8001sc1_conn_cur
8002sc2_conn_cur
8003 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8004 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8005 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8006
8007sc1_conn_rate
8008sc2_conn_rate
8009 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8010 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8011 See also src_conn_rate.
8012
8013sc1_get_gpc0
8014sc2_get_gpc0
8015 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8016 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8017
8018sc1_http_err_cnt
8019sc2_http_err_cnt
8020 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8021 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8022 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8023
8024sc1_http_err_rate
8025sc2_http_err_rate
8026 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8027 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8028 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8029 src_http_err_rate.
8030
8031sc1_http_req_cnt
8032sc2_http_req_cnt
8033 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8034 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8035 src_http_req_cnt.
8036
8037sc1_http_req_rate
8038sc2_http_req_rate
8039 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8040 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8041 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8042 src_http_req_rate.
8043
8044sc1_inc_gpc0
8045sc2_inc_gpc0
8046 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8047 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8048 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8049 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8050 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8051 when a first ACL was verified :
8052
8053 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8054 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8055 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8056
8057sc1_kbytes_in
8058sc2_kbytes_in
8059 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8060 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8061 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8062 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8063
8064sc1_kbytes_out
8065sc2_kbytes_out
8066 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8067 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8068 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8069 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8070
8071sc1_sess_cnt
8072sc2_sess_cnt
8073 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8074 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8075 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8076 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008077 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008078 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8079
8080sc1_sess_rate
8081sc2_sess_rate
8082 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8083 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8084 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8085 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8086 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008087 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008089so_id <integer>
8090 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8091
8092src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008093 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8094 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8095 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008096
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008097src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008098src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008099 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8100 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8101 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008102 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008103
8104src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008105src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008106 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8107 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8108 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008109 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008110
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008111src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8112src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8113 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8114 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8115 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8116 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8117 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8118 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8119
8120 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8121 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8122 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8123 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8124 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8125 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8126 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8127
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008128src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008129src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008130 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8131 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8132 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008133 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008134
8135src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008136src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008137 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8138 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8139 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008140 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008141
8142src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008143src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008144 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8145 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8146 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008147 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008148
8149src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008150src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008151 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8152 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8153 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008154 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008155
8156src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008157src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008158 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8159 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8160 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008161 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008162
8163src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008164src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008165 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8166 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8167 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8168 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008169 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008170
8171src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008172src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008173 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8174 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8175 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008176 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008177
8178src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008179src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008180 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8181 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8182 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8183 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008184 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008185
8186src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008187src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008188 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8189 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8190 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8191 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8192 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8193 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8194
8195 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8196 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008197 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008198
8199src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008200src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008201 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8202 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8203 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8204 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008205 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008206
8207src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008208src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008209 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8210 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8211 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8212 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008213 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008214
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008215src_port <integer>
8216 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008217
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008218src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008219src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008220 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8221 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8222 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8223 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008224 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008225
8226src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008227src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008228 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8229 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8230 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8231 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008232 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008233
8234src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008235src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008236 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008237 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8238 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008239 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8240 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8241 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008242 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008243
8244 Example :
8245 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8246 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8247 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8248 listen ssh
8249 bind :22
8250 mode tcp
8251 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008252 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008253 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8254 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8255
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008256srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008257 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8258 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8259 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8260 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8261
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008262srv_id <integer>
8263 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8264
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008265srv_is_up(<server>)
8266srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8267 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8268 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8269 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8270 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8271 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8272 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8273 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8274 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8275
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008276table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008277table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008278 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8279 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8280
8281table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008282table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008283 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8284 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8285 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008287
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020082887.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8289---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008290
8291A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8292during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008293through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8294keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008295
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008296rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8297 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8298 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8299 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008300 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8301 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8302 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008303
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008304req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008305 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008306 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8307 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8308 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8309 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8310 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8311 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8312
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008313req_proto_http
8314 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8315 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008316 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008317 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8318 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8319
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008320req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008321req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008322 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8323 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8324 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8325 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8326 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8327 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8328 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8329 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8330
8331req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008332req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008333 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8334 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8335 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8336 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8337 cookies.
8338
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008339req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8340 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8341 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8342 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008343 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8344 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8345 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008346
8347req_ssl_sni <string>
8348 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8349 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8350 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8351 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8352 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8353 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8354 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008355 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8356 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008357 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008358 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008359
8360 Examples :
8361 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8362 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8363 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8364 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8365 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8366
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008367req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8368 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8369 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8370 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8371 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8372 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8373 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008374 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8375 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008376 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008377 option.
8378
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008379ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8380 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8381 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8382 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8383 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8384 during this verification process.
8385
8386ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8387 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8388 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8389 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8390 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8391
8392ssl_c_err <integer>
8393 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8394 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8395 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8396 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8397
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008398ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8399ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8400 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8401 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8402 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8403 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8404 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8405 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8406 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8407 DN matches the specified string.
8408
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008409ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8410 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8411 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8412 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8413
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008414ssl_c_notafter <string>
8415 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8416 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8417 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8418
8419ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8420 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8421 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8422 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8423
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008424ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8425ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8426 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8427 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8428 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8429 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8430 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8431 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8432 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8433 DN matches the specified string.
8434
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008435ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8436 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8437 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8438 the value written in hexa.
8439
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008440ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8441 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8442 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8443 by the client matches the string.
8444
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008445ssl_c_verify <integer>
8446 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8447 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8448 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8449
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008450ssl_c_version <integer>
8451 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8452 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8453 the value.
8454
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008455ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8456ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8457 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8458 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8459 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8460 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8461 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8462 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8463 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8464 DN matches the specified string.
8465
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008466ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8467 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8468 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8469 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8470
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008471ssl_f_notafter <string>
8472 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8473 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8474 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8475
8476ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8477 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8478 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8479 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8480
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008481ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8482ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8483 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8484 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8485 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8486 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8487 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8488 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8489 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8490 DN matches the specified string.
8491
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008492ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8493 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8494 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8495 the value written in hexa.
8496
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008497ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8498 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8499 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8500 by the frontend matches the string.
8501
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008502ssl_f_version <integer>
8503 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8504 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8505 the value.
8506
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008507ssl_fc
8508 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8509 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8510 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8511
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008512ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8513 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8514 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8515
8516ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8517 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8518 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8519
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008520ssl_fc_has_crt
8521 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8522 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8523
8524ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008525 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008526 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8527 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8528 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8529 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008530
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008531ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008532 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8533 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8534 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8535 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008536 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8537 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8538 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008539
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008540ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8541 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8542 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8543
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008544ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008545 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8546 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8547 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8548 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008549 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8550 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008551 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8552 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8553 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008554
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008555ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008556 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8557 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8558 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8559 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008560 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8561 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8562 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8563 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008564
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008565ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008566 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8567 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8568 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8569 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008570 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8571 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8572 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8573 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008574
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008575ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8576 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8577 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8578
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008579wait_end
8580 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8581 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8582 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8583 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8584 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8585 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8586 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8587 inspection.
8588
8589 Examples :
8590 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8591 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8592 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8593
8594 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8595 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8596 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8597 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8598 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8599 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8600 tcp-request content reject
8601
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086037.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8604--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008605
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008606A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008607application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8608read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8609than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8610
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008611base <string>
8612 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8613 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8614 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8615 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8616 See also "path" and "uri".
8617
8618base_beg <string>
8619 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8620 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8621 "path_beg".
8622
8623base_dir <string>
8624 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8625 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8626 "path_dir" instead.
8627
8628base_dom <string>
8629 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8630 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8631 instead.
8632
8633base_end <string>
8634 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8635 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8636
8637base_len <integer>
8638 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8639 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8640
8641base_reg <regex>
8642 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8643 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8644 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8645 and all "base_" criteria.
8646
8647base_sub <string>
8648 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8649 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8650 also "base_dir".
8651
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008652cook(<name>) <string>
8653 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8654 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8655 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8656 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8657 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8658 sent by the server.
8659
8660 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8661 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8662 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8663
8664 cook(profile) silver gold
8665
8666cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8667 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8668 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8669 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8670
8671cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8672 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8673 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8674 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8675 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8676 server.
8677
8678cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8679 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8680 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8681 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8682 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8683 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8684
8685cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8686 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8687 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8688 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8689 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8690
8691cook_end(<name>) <string>
8692 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8693 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8694 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8695
8696cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8697 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8698 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8699 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8700 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8701 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8702
8703cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8704 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8705 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8706 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8707 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8708 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8709
8710cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8711 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8712 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8713 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8714
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008715cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8716 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8717 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8718 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8719 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8720 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8721
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008722hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008723hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008724 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8725 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8726 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8727 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008728 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8729 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8730 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8731 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8732 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008733
8734 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008735 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008736 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8737
8738 hdr(Connection) -i close
8739
8740hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008741hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008742 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8743 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8744 response headers sent by the server.
8745
8746hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008747hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008748 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8749 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8750 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8751 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8752 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8753 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8754 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8755
8756hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008757hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008758 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8759 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8760 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8761 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8762 headers sent by the server.
8763
8764hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008765hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008766 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8767 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8768 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8769 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8770 server.
8771
8772hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008773hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8775 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8776 response headers sent by the server.
8777
8778hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008779hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8780 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8781 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8782 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008783 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8784
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008785hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008786hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008787 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8788 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8789 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8790 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8791
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008793hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008794 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008795 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8796 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8797 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8798 response headers sent by the server.
8799
8800hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008801hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8803 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8804 response headers sent by the server.
8805
8806hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008807hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008808 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8809 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8810 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8811 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8812
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008813http_auth(<userlist>)
8814http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008815 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8816 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8817 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8818 of specified groups.
8819
8820 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8821
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008822http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008823 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8824 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8825 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8826 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8827
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008828method <string>
8829 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8830 already check for most common methods.
8831
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008832path <string>
8833 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8834 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8835 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8836
8837path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008838 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8839 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008841path_dir <string>
8842 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8843 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8844 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8845 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8846
8847path_dom <string>
8848 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8849 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8850 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8851
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008852path_end <string>
8853 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8854 control file name extension.
8855
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008856path_len <integer>
8857 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8858 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8859
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008860path_reg <regex>
8861 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8862 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8863 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008865path_sub <string>
8866 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8867 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8868 "path_dir".
8869
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008870payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8871 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8872 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8873 strings.
8874
8875payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8876 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8877 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8878 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8879 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8880 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8881
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008882req_ver <string>
8883 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8884 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8885
8886status <integer>
8887 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8888 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8889 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8890
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008891url <string>
8892 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008893 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008894
8895url_beg <string>
8896 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008897 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8898 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008900url_dir <string>
8901 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8902 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8903 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8904 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8905
8906url_dom <string>
8907 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8908 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8909 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8910
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008911url_end <string>
8912 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8913 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008914
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008915url_ip <address>
8916 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8917 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8918 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008919
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008920url_len <integer>
8921 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8922 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8923
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008924url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008925 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8926 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008927 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008928 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008930url_reg <regex>
8931 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8932 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008933 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008935url_sub <string>
8936 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8937 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008938
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008939urlp(<name>) <string>
8940 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8941 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8942
8943 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8944 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8945
8946urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8947 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8948 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8949 protocol scheme.
8950
8951urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8952 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8953 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8954 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8955 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8956
8957urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8958 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8959 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8960 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8961 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8962
8963urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8964 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8965
8966urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008967 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8968 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008969
8970urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8971 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8972 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8973
8974urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8975 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8976 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8977 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8978 "urlp_" criteria.
8979
8980urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8981 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8982 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8983 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8984
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02008985urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
8986 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
8987 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
8988 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
8989 negative data.
8990
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020089927.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8993---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008995Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8996every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008997order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008999ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9000---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009001FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009002HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009003HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9004HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009005HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9006HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9007HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9008HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9009LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009010METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9011METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9012METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9013METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9014METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9015METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009016RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009017REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009018TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009019WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9020---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009021
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090237.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9024----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009026Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9027combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009029 - AND (implicit)
9030 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9031 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009033A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009035 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009037Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9038indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009039
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009040For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9041"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9042requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9043is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009045 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9046 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9047 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9048 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009050To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9051and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009053 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9054 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9055 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9056 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009058 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9059 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9060 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9061 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009062
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009063It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9064expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9065be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009066the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009067
9068 The following rule :
9069
9070 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9071 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9072
9073 Can also be written that way :
9074
9075 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9076
9077It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9078to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9079simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9080sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9081good use is the following :
9082
9083 With named ACLs :
9084
9085 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9086 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9087 monitor fail if site_dead
9088
9089 With anonymous ACLs :
9090
9091 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009094
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009095
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010090967.8. Pattern extraction
9097-----------------------
9098
9099The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9100response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9101for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9102
9103All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9104"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9105begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9106arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9107much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9108equivalent used in ACLs.
9109
9110The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9111
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009112 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9113 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9114 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9115 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9116 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9117 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9118 requested objects by host/path.
9119
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009120 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009121 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9122 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9123 according to RFC 4291.
9124
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009125 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9126 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9127 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009128 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9129 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9130 according to RFC 4291.
9131
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009132 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9133 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9134 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9135 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9136 type integer and only works with such tables.
9137
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009138 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9139 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9140 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9141 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9142 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9143 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9144 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009145 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009146
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009147 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9148 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9149 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9150 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9151 wiser to use "url" instead.
9152
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009153 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009154 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9155 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9156 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9157 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009158
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009159 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009160 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9161 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9162 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9163 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9164 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9165 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9166 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9167 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009168
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009169 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9170 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9171 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9172 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9173
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009174 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9175 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9176
9177 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9178 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9179 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9180
9181 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9182 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9183
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009184 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9185 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9186 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9187 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9188 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9189 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9190 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9191 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9192 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9193 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9194 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9195
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009196 ssl_c_key_alg
9197 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9198 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9199 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9200
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009201 ssl_c_notafter
9202 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9203 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9204 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9205
9206 ssl_c_notbefore
9207 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9208 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9209 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9210
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009211 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9212 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9213 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9214 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9215 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9216 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9217 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9218 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9219 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9220 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9221 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9222
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009223 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9224 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9225 layer.
9226
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009227 ssl_c_sig_alg
9228 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9229 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9230 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9231
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009232 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9233 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9234 error is encountered.
9235
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009236 ssl_c_version
9237 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9238 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9239 layer.
9240
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009241 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9242 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9243 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9244 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9245 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9246 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9247 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9248 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9249 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9250 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9251 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9252
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009253 ssl_f_key_alg
9254 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9255 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9256 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9257
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009258 ssl_f_notafter
9259 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9260 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9261 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9262
9263 ssl_f_notbefore
9264 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9265 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9266 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9267
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009268 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9269 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9270 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9271 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9272 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9273 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9274 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9275 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9276 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9277 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9278 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9279
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009280 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9281 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9282 layer.
9283
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009284 ssl_f_sig_alg
9285 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9286 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9287 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9288
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009289 ssl_f_version
9290 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9291 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9292 layer.
9293
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009294 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9295 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9296 otherwise zero.
9297
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009298 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9299 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9300 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9301
9302 ssl_fc_cipher
9303 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9304 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9305
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009306 ssl_fc_has_crt
9307 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9308 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9309
9310 ssl_fc_has_sni
9311 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009312 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9313 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009314 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009315 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009316
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009317 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009318 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9319 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9320 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9321 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009322 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009323
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009324 ssl_fc_protocol
9325 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection
9326 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9327
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009328 ssl_fc_session_id
9329 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9330 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9331 stick on a given client.
9332
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009333 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009334 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9335 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9336 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9337 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9338 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009339
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009340 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9341 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9342 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9343
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009344 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9345 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9346 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9347 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9348
9349 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9350 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9351 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9352 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9353 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9354 table for a given source address.
9355
9356 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9357 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9358
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009359 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009360 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009361 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9362 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9363 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9364 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9365 where cookies cannot be used.
9366
9367 Example :
9368 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9369 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9370 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9371 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009372
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009373 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009374 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9375 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9376 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9377 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009378
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009379 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9380 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9381 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9382 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9383 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9384 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9385 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009386
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009387 Example :
9388 listen tse-farm
9389 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9390 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9391 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9392 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9393 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9394 persist rdp-cookie
9395 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9396 # This is only useful makes sense if
9397 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9398 stick-table type string size 204800
9399 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9400 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9401 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009402
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009403 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9404 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009405
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009406 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009407 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009408 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9409 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9410 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9411 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9412 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9413 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009414
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009415 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009416
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009417 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009418 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9419 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9420 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9421
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009422 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9423 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9424 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9425 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9426 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009427
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009428 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009429
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009430
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009431The currently available list of transformations include :
9432
9433 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9434 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9435 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9436
9437 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9438 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9439 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9440
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009441 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009442 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9443 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9444 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9445 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9446
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094488. Logging
9449----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009451One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9452provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9453very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9454provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9455state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009456to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009457headers.
9458
9459In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9460about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9461send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9462
9463 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9464 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9465 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9466 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9467 at the termination.
9468
9469The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9470allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9471as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9472while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9473real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9474delay.
9475
9476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094778.1. Log levels
9478---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009479
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009480TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009481source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009482HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9483in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9484track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9485syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9486about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009487
9488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094898.2. Log formats
9490----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009492HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009493and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9494slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9495options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009496
9497 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9498 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9499 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9500 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9501 extents.
9502
9503 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9504 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9505 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9506 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9507 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9508
9509 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9510 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9511 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9512 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9513 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9514
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009515 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9516 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9517 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9518 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9519
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009520 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009522Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9523specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9524field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9525servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9526always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9527identifier.
9528
9529Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9530 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9531 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9532 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9533 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9534
9535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095368.2.1. Default log format
9537-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009538
9539This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9540as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9541format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9542
9543 Example :
9544 listen www
9545 mode http
9546 log global
9547 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9548
9549 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9550 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9551 (www/HTTP)
9552
9553 Field Format Extract from the example above
9554 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9555 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9556 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9557 4 'to' to
9558 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9559 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9560
9561Detailed fields description :
9562 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9563 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9564 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9565 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9566 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9567 and processed the connection.
9568 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9569
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009570In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9571"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9572connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9573
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009574It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9575will eventually disappear.
9576
9577
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095788.2.2. TCP log format
9579---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009580
9581The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9582is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9583information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9584counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9585emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9586environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9587the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9588sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009589specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9590not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9591fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9592marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009593
9594 Example :
9595 frontend fnt
9596 mode tcp
9597 option tcplog
9598 log global
9599 default_backend bck
9600
9601 backend bck
9602 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9603
9604 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9605 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9606 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9607
9608 Field Format Extract from the example above
9609 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9610 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9611 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9612 4 frontend_name fnt
9613 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9614 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9615 7 bytes_read* 212
9616 8 termination_state --
9617 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9618 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9619
9620Detailed fields description :
9621 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009622 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9623 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9624 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9625 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9626 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009627
9628 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009629 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9630 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9631 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009632
9633 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9634 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9635 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9636 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9637
9638 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9639 and processed the connection.
9640
9641 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9642 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9643 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9644 applications.
9645
9646 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9647 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9648 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9649 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9650 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9651
9652 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9653 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9654 See "Timers" below for more details.
9655
9656 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9657 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9658 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9659 "Timers" below for more details.
9660
9661 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9662 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9663 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9664 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9665 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9666 details.
9667
9668 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9669 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9670 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9671 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9672 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9673
9674 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9675 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9676 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9677 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9678 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9679 for more details.
9680
9681 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009682 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009683 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9684 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9685 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009686 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009687
9688 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9689 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9690 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9691 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9692 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9693 caused by a denial of service attack.
9694
9695 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9696 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9697 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9698 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9699 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9700 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9701 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9702 denial of service attack.
9703
9704 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9705 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9706 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9707 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9708 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9709 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9710 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9711 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9712 be processed than on other servers.
9713
9714 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9715 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9716 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9717 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9718 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9719 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9720 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9721 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9722 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9723 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9724 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9725 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9726 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9727
9728 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9729 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9730 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9731 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9732 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9733 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9734 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9735 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9736
9737 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9738 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9739 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9740 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9741 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9742 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9743 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9744 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9745 occurs.
9746
9747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097488.2.3. HTTP log format
9749----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009750
9751The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9752is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9753the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9754are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9755emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9756generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9757"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9758which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009759frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9760is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009761
9762Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9763slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9764with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9765
9766 Example :
9767 frontend http-in
9768 mode http
9769 option httplog
9770 log global
9771 default_backend bck
9772
9773 backend static
9774 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9775
9776 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9777 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9778 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009779 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009780
9781 Field Format Extract from the example above
9782 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9783 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9784 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9785 4 frontend_name http-in
9786 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9787 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9788 7 status_code 200
9789 8 bytes_read* 2750
9790 9 captured_request_cookie -
9791 10 captured_response_cookie -
9792 11 termination_state ----
9793 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9794 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9795 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9796 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9797 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009798
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009799
9800Detailed fields description :
9801 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009802 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9803 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9804 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9805 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9806 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009807
9808 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009809 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9810 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9811 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009812
9813 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9814 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9815 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9816 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9817 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9818
9819 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9820 and processed the connection.
9821
9822 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9823 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9824 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9825
9826 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9827 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9828 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9829 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9830 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9831 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9832
9833 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9834 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9835 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9836 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9837 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9838 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9839
9840 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9841 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9842 See "Timers" below for more details.
9843
9844 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9845 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9846 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9847 below for more details.
9848
9849 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9850 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9851 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9852 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9853 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9854 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9855 for more details.
9856
9857 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9858 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9859 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9860 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9861 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9862 details.
9863
9864 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9865 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9866 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9867
9868 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9869 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9870 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9871 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9872 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9873 overflowing.
9874
9875 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9876 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9877 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9878 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9879 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9880 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9881 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9882 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9883
9884 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9885 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9886 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9887 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9888 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9889 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9890 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9891 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9892
9893 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9894 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9895 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9896 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9897 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9898 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9899 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9900
9901 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009902 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009903 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9904 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9905 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009906 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009907 system.
9908
9909 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9910 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9911 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9912 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9913 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9914 caused by a denial of service attack.
9915
9916 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9917 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9918 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9919 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9920 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9921 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9922 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9923 denial of service attack.
9924
9925 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9926 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9927 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9928 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9929 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9930 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9931 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9932 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9933 processed than on other servers.
9934
9935 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9936 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9937 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9938 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9939 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9940 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9941 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9942 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9943 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9944 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9945 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9946 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9947 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9948
9949 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9950 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9951 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9952 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9953 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9954 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9955 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9956 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9957
9958 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9959 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9960 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9961 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9962 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9963 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9964 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9965 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9966 occurs.
9967
9968 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9969 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9970 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9971 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9972 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9973 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9974 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9975 cookies" below for more details.
9976
9977 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9978 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9979 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9980 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9981 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9982 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9983 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9984 and cookies" below for more details.
9985
9986 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9987 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9988 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9989 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9990 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9991 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9992 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9993 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9994
9995
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020099968.2.4. Custom log format
9997------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009998
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009999The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10000mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010001
10002HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10003Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10004separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10005prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10006
10007Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10008variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10009string formats ("Q").
10010
10011Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10012HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10013
10014Flags are :
10015 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010016 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010017
10018 Example:
10019
10020 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10021 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10022
10023At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10024
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010025 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010026 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010027
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010028the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010029
10030 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010031 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010032 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10033
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010034and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10035
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010036 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010037 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10038
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010039Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10040
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010041 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010042 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010043 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10044 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10045 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10046 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010047 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010048 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010049 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010050 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010051 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10052 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10053 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010054 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010055 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10056 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10057 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010058 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010059 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010060 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10061 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010062 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010063 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10064 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10065 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10066 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10067 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10068 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010069 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10070 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10071 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010072 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010073 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010074 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010075 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10076 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10077 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10078 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010079 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010080 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010081 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010082 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10083 | | %s | server_name | string |
10084 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10085 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010086 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10087 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10088 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010089 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010090 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010091 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010092 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010093
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010094 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200100968.3. Advanced logging options
10097-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010098
10099Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10100just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10101options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10102for more information about their usage.
10103
10104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10106------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010107
10108It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10109haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10110commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10111monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10112ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10113
10114 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10115 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10116 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10117 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10118
10119 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10120 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10121 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10122 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10123 such as other load-balancers.
10124
10125 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10126 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10127 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10128
10129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10131----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010132
10133The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10134what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10135or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10136"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10137just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10138log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10139after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10140is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10141with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10142with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10143
10144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10146------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010147
10148Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10149for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10150"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10151retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10152raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10153a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10154file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10155you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10156"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10157
10158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10160--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010161
10162Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10163multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10164them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10165"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10166logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10167error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10168and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10169too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10170useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10171alternative.
10172
10173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101748.4. Timing events
10175------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010176
10177Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10178reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10179the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10180frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10181mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10182
10183 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10184 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10185 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10186 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10187 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10188
10189 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10190 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10191 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10192 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10193 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10194
10195 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10196 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10197 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10198 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10199 connection never established.
10200
10201 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10202 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10203 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10204 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10205 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10206 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10207 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10208 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10209 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10210 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10211 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10212
10213 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10214 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10215 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10216 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10217 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10218
10219 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10220
10221 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10222 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10223 negative.
10224
10225These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10226protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10227that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010228due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010229close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10230session has been aborted on timeout.
10231
10232Most common cases :
10233
10234 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10235 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10236 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10237 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10238 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10239 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10240 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10241 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10242 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010243 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10244 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10245 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010246
10247 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10248 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10249 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10250 of ms on remote networks.
10251
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010252 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10253 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10254 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010255
10256 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10257 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10258 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10259 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10260 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10261 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10262 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10263 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10264 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10265 to the server until another one is released.
10266
10267Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10268
10269 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10270 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10271 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10272
10273 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10274 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10275 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10276
10277 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10278 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10279 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10280 flags.
10281
10282 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10283 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10284 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10285 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10286 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10287 the client connection was maintained open.
10288
10289 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10290 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10291 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10292 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10293
10294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102958.5. Session state at disconnection
10296-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010297
10298TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10299"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103002-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10301each of which has a special meaning :
10302
10303 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10304 session to terminate :
10305
10306 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10307
10308 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10309 server explicitly refused it.
10310
10311 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10312 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10313 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10314 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10315 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10316 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10317
10318 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10319 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10320 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10321 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10322 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10323
10324 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10325 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10326 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10327 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10328 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10329
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010330 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10331 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10332
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010333 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10334 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10335 backup connections when going up.
10336
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010337 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10338
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010339 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10340 send or receive data.
10341
10342 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10343 send or receive data.
10344
10345 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10346 with nothing left in the buffers.
10347
10348 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10349
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010350 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010351 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10352
10353 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10354 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10355 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10356 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10357 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10358
10359 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10360 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10361
10362 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10363 server (HTTP only).
10364
10365 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10366
10367 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10368 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10369 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10370
10371 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10372 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10373 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10374
10375 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10376
10377 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10378 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10379
10380 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10381 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10382 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10383
10384 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10385 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010386 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10387 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010388
10389 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10390 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10391 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10392 another server.
10393
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010394 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010395 server.
10396
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010397 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10398 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10399 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10400 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10401
10402 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10403 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10404 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10405 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10406
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010407 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10408 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10409 "use-server" rule).
10410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010411 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10412
10413 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10414 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10415
10416 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10417
10418 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10419 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10420 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010422 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10423 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10424 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10425 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10426 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10427
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010428 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10429
10430 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10431 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10432
10433 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10434
10435 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10436
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010437The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10438was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010439helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10440starvation, attacks, etc...
10441
10442The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10443alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10444easier finding and understanding.
10445
10446 Flags Reason
10447
10448 -- Normal termination.
10449
10450 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10451 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10452 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10453 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10454
10455 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10456 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10457 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10458 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10459 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10460 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010461
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010462 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10463 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010464 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010465
10466 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10467 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10468 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10469
10470 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10471 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10472 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10473 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10474 the server takes too long to respond.
10475
10476 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10477 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10478 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10479 long a time to respond.
10480
10481 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10482 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10483 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10484 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10485 and the client.
10486
10487 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10488 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10489 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10490 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10491 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10492 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10493
10494 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10495 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010496 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10497 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10498 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10499 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010501 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010502 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10503 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10504 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10505 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10506 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10507
10508 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10509 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10510 503 or 504 here.
10511
10512 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10513 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10514 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10515 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10516 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10517
10518 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10519 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010520 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010521 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10522 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10523
10524 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10525 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10526 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10527 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10528 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10529 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10530 between haproxy and the server.
10531
10532 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10533 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10534 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10535 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10536 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10537 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10538 solution is to fix the application.
10539
10540 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10541 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10542 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10543 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10544 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10545 external attacks.
10546
10547 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10548 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010549 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010550 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10551 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10552
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010553 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10554 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10555 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10556 the client.
10557
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010558 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10559 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10560 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10561 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010562 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10563 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10564 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10565 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10566 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010567
10568 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10569 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10570 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10571 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10572
10573 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10574 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10575 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10576 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10577
10578 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10579 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10580 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10581 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010583The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10584persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10585important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10586re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10587
10588 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10589
10590 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10591 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10592 set on a GET request.
10593
10594 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10595 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010596 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010597 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10598
10599 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10600 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10601 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10602
10603 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10604 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10605 already got a cookie.
10606
10607 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10608 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10609 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10610 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10611 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10612
10613 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10614 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10615 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10616
10617 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10618 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10619 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10620
10621 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10622 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10623
10624 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10625 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10626 then advertised in the response.
10627
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106298.6. Non-printable characters
10630-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010631
10632In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10633consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10634converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10635prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10636being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10637escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10638is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10639'}' when logging headers.
10640
10641Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10642issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10643containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10644
10645Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10646the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10647performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10648
10649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106508.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10651---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010652
10653Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10654achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010655section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010656cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10657the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10658the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010659locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010660not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10661user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10662a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10663wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10664
10665 Examples :
10666 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10667 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10668
10669 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10670 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10671
10672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106738.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10674---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010675
10676Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10677proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10678the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10679server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10680
10681Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10682response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010683section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010684
10685It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010686time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10687appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010688are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10689and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10690follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10691request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10692in the logs.
10693
10694 Example :
10695 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10696 listen proxy-out
10697 mode http
10698 option httplog
10699 option logasap
10700 log global
10701 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10702
10703 # log the name of the virtual server
10704 capture request header Host len 20
10705
10706 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10707 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10708
10709 # log the beginning of the referrer
10710 capture request header Referer len 20
10711
10712 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10713 capture response header Server len 20
10714
10715 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10716 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10717
10718 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10719 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10720
10721 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10722 capture response header Via len 20
10723
10724 # log the URL location during a redirection
10725 capture response header Location len 20
10726
10727 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10728 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10729 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10730 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10731 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10732
10733 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10734 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10735 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10736 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010737 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010738
10739 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10740 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10741 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10742 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10743 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010744 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010745
10746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107478.9. Examples of logs
10748---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010749
10750These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10751them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10752reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10753
10754 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10755 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10756 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10757
10758 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10759 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10760
10761 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10762 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10763 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10764
10765 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10766 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10767
10768 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10769 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10770 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10771
10772 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010773 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010774 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10775 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10776
10777 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10778 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10779 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10780
10781 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10782 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010783 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010784 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10785 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10786 to return the 502 and not the server.
10787
10788 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010789 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010790
10791 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10792 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10793 Nothing was sent to any server.
10794
10795 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10796 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10797
10798 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10799 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10800 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10801 send a 408 return code to the client.
10802
10803 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10804 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10805
10806 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10807 5 seconds ("c----").
10808
10809 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10810 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010811 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010812
10813 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010814 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010815 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10816 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10817 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10818 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10819 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010820
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108229. Statistics and monitoring
10823----------------------------
10824
10825It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10826mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10827CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10828Unix socket.
10829
10830
108319.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010832---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010833
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010834The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10835page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010837 0. pxname: proxy name
10838 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10839 for server)
10840 2. qcur: current queued requests
10841 3. qmax: max queued requests
10842 4. scur: current sessions
10843 5. smax: max sessions
10844 6. slim: sessions limit
10845 7. stot: total sessions
10846 8. bin: bytes in
10847 9. bout: bytes out
10848 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010849 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010850 12. ereq: request errors
10851 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010852 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010853 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10854 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010855 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010856 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10857 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10858 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10859 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10860 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10861 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10862 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10863 25. qlimit: queue limit
10864 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10865 27. iid: unique proxy id
10866 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10867 29. throttle: warm up status
10868 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10869 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010870 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010871 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10872 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10873 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010874 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010875 UNK -> unknown
10876 INI -> initializing
10877 SOCKERR -> socket error
10878 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10879 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10880 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10881 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10882 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10883 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10884 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10885 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10886 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10887 disable-on-404
10888 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10889 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10890 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010891 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10892 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010893 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10894 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10895 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10896 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10897 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10898 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010899 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10900 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10901 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10902 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010903 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10904 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010905
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109079.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010908-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010909
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010910The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010911must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10912is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10913a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10914risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10915followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10916given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10917then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10918to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010919
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010920It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10921on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10922own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010924clear counters
10925 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10926 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10927 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10928 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10929 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10930
10931clear counters all
10932 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10933 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10934 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10935
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010936clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10937 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10938
10939 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10940 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10941 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10942 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10943 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10944 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10945
10946 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10947
10948 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10949 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10950 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10951 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10952 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10953 the ACLs :
10954
10955 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10956 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10957 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10958 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10959 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10960 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10961
10962 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010963 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10964 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010965
10966 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010967 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010968 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010969 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10970 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10971 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10972 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010973
10974 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10975
10976 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010977 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010978 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10979 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010980 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10981 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10982 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010983
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010984disable frontend <frontend>
10985 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10986 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10987 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10988 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10989 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10990 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10991 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10992 on the stats page.
10993
10994 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10995 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10996
10997 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10998 level "admin".
10999
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011000disable server <backend>/<server>
11001 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11002 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11003 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11004 during the maintenance.
11005
11006 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11007 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11008
11009 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011010 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011011
11012 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11013 level "admin".
11014
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011015enable frontend <frontend>
11016 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11017 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11018 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11019 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11020 which was disabled.
11021
11022 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11023 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11024
11025 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11026 level "admin".
11027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011028enable server <backend>/<server>
11029 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11030 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11031
11032 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011033 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011034
11035 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11036 level "admin".
11037
11038get weight <backend>/<server>
11039 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11040 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11041 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11042 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11043 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011044 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011046help
11047 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11048 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011049
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011050prompt
11051 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11052 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11053 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11054 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11055 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11056 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11057 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11058 command.
11059
11060quit
11061 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011062
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011063set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011064 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11065 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11066 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11067 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11068 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011069 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11070 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11071
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011072set maxconn global <maxconn>
11073 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11074 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11075 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11076 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11077 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11078 setting.
11079
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011080set rate-limit connections global <value>
11081 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11082 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11083 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11084 is passed in number of connections per second.
11085
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011086set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11087 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11088 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11089 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11090 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11091 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11092
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011093set timeout cli <delay>
11094 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11095 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11096 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11097
11098set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11099 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11100 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11101 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11102 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11103 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11104 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11105 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11106 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11107 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11108 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11109 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11110 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11111 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011112 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011113
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011114show errors [<iid>]
11115 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11116 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011117 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11118 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11119 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011120
11121 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11122 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11123 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11124 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11125 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11126 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11127 are reported too.
11128
11129 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11130 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11131 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11132 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11133 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11134 code.
11135
11136 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11137 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11138 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11139 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11140 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11141 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11142 line.
11143
11144 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011145 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11146 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011147 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11148 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11149
11150 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11151 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11152 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11153 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11154 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11155 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11156 00204+ minal\r\n
11157 00211 \r\n
11158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011159 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011160 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11161 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11162 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11163 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11164 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11165 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011166
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011167show info
11168 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11169
11170show sess
11171 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011172 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11173 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11174
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011175show sess <id>
11176 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11177 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11178 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11179 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11180 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11181 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011182
11183show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11184 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11185 possible to dump only selected items :
11186 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11187 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11188 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11189 for example:
11190 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11191 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11192 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11193
11194 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011195 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11196 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011197 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11198 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11199 Nbproc: 1
11200 Process_num: 1
11201 (...)
11202
11203 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11204 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11205 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11206 (...)
11207 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11208
11209 $
11210
11211 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11212 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11213 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11214 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011215 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011216
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011217show table
11218 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11219 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11220 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11221 entries currently in use.
11222
11223 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011224 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011225 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11226 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011227
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011228show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011229 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11230 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11231 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011232 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11233
11234 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11235 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11236 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11237 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11238 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11239
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011240 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11241 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11242 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11243 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11244 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11245 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11246
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011247
11248 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011249 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11250 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011251
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011252 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011253 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011254 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011255 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11256 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11257 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11258 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011259
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011260 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011261 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011262 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11263 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011264
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011265 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11266 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011267 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011268 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11269 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011270
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011271 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11272 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011273 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011274 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11275 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11276
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011277 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11278 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11279 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11280 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11281 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11282
11283 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11284 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11285 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011286 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11287 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011288 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11289 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011290
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011291shutdown frontend <frontend>
11292 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11293 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11294 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11295 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11296 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11297 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11298 once it is terminated.
11299
11300 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11301 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11302
11303 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11304 level "admin".
11305
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011306shutdown session <id>
11307 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11308 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11309 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11310 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11311 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11312 flag in the logs.
11313
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011314shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11315 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11316 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11317 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11318 'K' flag in the logs.
11319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011320/*
11321 * Local variables:
11322 * fill-column: 79
11323 * End:
11324 */